smb.conf.5.html   [plain text]


<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smb.conf</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.64.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smb.conf.5"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smb.conf &#8212; The configuration file for the Samba suite</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2431071"></a><h2>SYNOPSIS</h2><p>The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file is a configuration  
	file for the Samba suite. <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> contains  
	runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file 
	is designed to be configured and  administered by the <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> program. The complete
	description of the file format and possible parameters held within
	are here for reference purposes.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="FILEFORMATSECT"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>The file consists of sections and parameters. A section 
	begins with the name of the section in square brackets and continues 
	until the next section begins. Sections contain parameters of the 
	form</p><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>value
	</tt></i></p><p>The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated 
	line represents either a comment, a section name or a parameter.</p><p>Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.</p><p>Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant. 
	Whitespace before or after the first equals sign is discarded.
	Leading, trailing and internal whitespace in section and parameter 
	names is irrelevant. Leading and trailing whitespace in a parameter 
	value is discarded. Internal whitespace within a parameter value 
	is retained verbatim.</p><p>Any line beginning with a semicolon (&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>;</em></span></span>&#8221;) or a hash (&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>#</em></span></span>&#8221;) 
	character is ignored, as are lines containing only whitespace.</p><p>Any line ending in a &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>\</em></span></span>&#8221; is continued
	on the next line in the customary UNIX fashion.</p><p>The values following the equals sign in parameters are all 
	either a string (no quotes needed) or a boolean, which may be given 
	as yes/no, 0/1 or true/false. Case is not significant in boolean 
	values, but is preserved in string values. Some items such as 
	create modes are numeric.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2478518"></a><h2>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</h2><p>Each section in the configuration file (except for the
	[global] section) describes a shared resource (known
	as a &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>share</em></span></span>&#8221;). The section name is the name of the 
	shared resource and the parameters within the section define 
	the shares attributes.</p><p>There are three special sections, [global],
	[homes] and [printers], which are
	described under <span class="emphasis"><em>special sections</em></span>. The
	following notes apply to ordinary section descriptions.</p><p>A share consists of a directory to which access is being 
	given plus a description of the access rights which are granted 
	to the user of the service. Some housekeeping options are 
	also specifiable.</p><p>Sections are either file share services (used by the 
	client as an extension of their native file systems) or 
	printable services (used by the client to access print services 
	on the host running the server).</p><p>Sections may be designated <span class="emphasis"><em>guest</em></span> services,
	in which case no password is required to access them. A specified 
	UNIX <span class="emphasis"><em>guest account</em></span> is used to define access
	privileges in this case.</p><p>Sections other than guest services will require a password 
	to access them. The client provides the username. As older clients 
	only provide passwords and not usernames, you may specify a list 
	of usernames to check against the password using the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>user =</em></span></span>&#8221;
	option in the share definition. For modern clients such as 
	Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000, this should not be necessary.</p><p>The access rights granted by the server are 
	masked by the access rights granted to the specified or guest 
	UNIX user by the host system. The server does not grant more
	access than the host system grants.</p><p>The following sample section defines a file space share. 
	The user has write access to the path <tt class="filename">/home/bar</tt>. 
	The share is accessed via the share name &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>foo</em></span></span>&#8221;:</p><div class="example"><a name="id2430083"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 1. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[foo]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2430100"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				path = /home/bar</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2430116"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				read only = read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p>The following sample section defines a printable share. 
	The share is read-only, but printable. That is, the only write 
	access permitted is via calls to open, write to and close a 
	spool file. The <span class="emphasis"><em>guest ok</em></span> parameter means 
	access will be permitted as the default guest user (specified 
	elsewhere):</p><div class="example"><a name="id2430144"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[aprinter]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2430160"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				path = /usr/spool/public</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2430176"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2430192"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2430207"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2430224"></a><h2>SPECIAL SECTIONS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2430230"></a><h3>The [global] section</h3><p>Parameters in this section apply to the server 
		as a whole, or are defaults for sections that do not 
		specifically define certain items. See the notes
		under PARAMETERS for more information.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="HOMESECT"></a><h3>The [homes] section</h3><p>If a section called [homes] is included in the 
		configuration file, services connecting clients to their 
		home directories can be created on the fly by the server.</p><p>When the connection request is made, the existing 
		sections are scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no 
		match is found, the requested section name is treated as a 
		username and looked up in the local password file. If the 
		name exists and the correct password has been given, a share is 
		created by cloning the [homes] section.</p><p>Some modifications are then made to the newly 
		created share:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The share name is changed from homes to 
		the located username.</p></li><li><p>If no path was given, the path is set to
		the user's home directory.</p></li></ul></div><p>If you decide to use a <span class="emphasis"><em>path =</em></span> line 
		in your [homes] section, you may find it useful 
		to use the %S macro. For example :</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>path = /data/pchome/%S</tt></b></p><p>is useful if you have different home directories 
		for your PCs than for UNIX access.</p><p>This is a fast and simple way to give a large number 
		of clients access to their home directories with a minimum 
		of fuss.</p><p>A similar process occurs if the requested section 
		name is &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>homes</em></span></span>&#8221;, except that the share name is not 
		changed to that of the requesting user. This method of using
		the [homes] section works well if different users share 
		a client PC.</p><p>The [homes] section can specify all the parameters 
		a normal service section can specify, though some make more sense 
		than others. The following is a typical and suitable [homes]
		section:</p><div class="example"><a name="id2429164"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 3. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2429181"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p>An important point is that if guest access is specified 
		in the [homes] section, all home directories will be 
		visible to all clients <span class="emphasis"><em>without a password</em></span>. 
		In the very unlikely event that this is actually desirable, it 
		is wise to also specify <span class="emphasis"><em>read only access</em></span>.</p><p>The <span class="emphasis"><em>browseable</em></span> flag for 
		auto home directories will be inherited from the global browseable 
		flag, not the [homes] browseable flag. This is useful as 
		it means setting <span class="emphasis"><em>browseable = no</em></span> in
		the [homes] section will hide the [homes] share but make
		any auto home directories visible.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="PRINTERSSECT"></a><h3>The [printers] section</h3><p>This section works like [homes], 
		but for printers.</p><p>If a [printers] section occurs in the 
		configuration file, users are able to connect to any printer 
		specified in the local host's printcap file.</p><p>When a connection request is made, the existing sections 
		are scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no match is found, 
		but a [homes] section exists, it is used as described
		above. Otherwise, the requested section name is treated as a
		printer name and the appropriate printcap file is scanned to see 
		if the requested section name is a valid printer share name. If 
		a match is found, a new printer share is created by cloning 
		the [printers] section.</p><p>A few modifications are then made to the newly created 
		share:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The share name is set to the located printer 
		name</p></li><li><p>If no printer name was given, the printer name 
		is set to the located printer name</p></li><li><p>If the share does not permit guest access and 
		no username was given, the username is set to the located 
		printer name.</p></li></ul></div><p>The [printers] service MUST be 
		printable - if you specify otherwise, the server will refuse 
		to load the configuration file.</p><p>Typically the path specified is that of a 
		world-writeable spool directory with the sticky bit set on 
		it. A typical [printers] entry looks like 
		this:</p><div class="example"><a name="id2429295"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 4. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2429311"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				path = /usr/spool/public</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2429327"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><a class="indexterm" name="id2429342"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>
					
				printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p>All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file 
		are legitimate printer names as far as the server is concerned. 
		If your printing subsystem doesn't work like that, you will have 
		to set up a pseudo-printcap. This is a file consisting of one or 
		more lines like this:</p><pre class="programlisting">
alias|alias|alias|alias...    
		</pre><p>Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for 
		your printing subsystem. In the [global] section, specify 
		the new file as your printcap.  The server will only recognize 
		names found in your pseudo-printcap, which of course can contain 
		whatever aliases you like. The same technique could be used 
		simply to limit access to a subset of your local printers.</p><p>An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the 
		first entry of a printcap record. Records are separated by newlines,
		components (if there are more than one) are separated by vertical 
		bar symbols (&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>|</em></span></span>&#8221;).</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what 
		printers are defined on the system you may be able to use
		&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>printcap name = lpstat</em></span></span>&#8221; to automatically obtain a list 
		of printers. See the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>printcap name</em></span></span>&#8221; option 
		for more details.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2429411"></a><h2>PARAMETERS</h2><p>Parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</p><p>Some parameters are specific to the [global] section
	(e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span>).  Some parameters are usable 
	in all sections (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>create mode</em></span>). All others 
	are permissible only in normal sections. For the purposes of the 
	following descriptions the [homes] and [printers]
	sections will be considered normal.  The letter <span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span> 
	in parentheses indicates that a parameter is specific to the
	[global] section. The letter <span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>
	indicates that a parameter can be specified in a service specific
	section. All <span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span> parameters can also be specified in 
	the [global] section - in which case they will define
	the default behavior for all services.</p><p>Parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may 
	not create best bedfellows, but at least you can find them! Where
	there are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer 
	to the preferred synonym.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2429460"></a><h2>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</h2><p>Many of the strings that are settable in the config file 
	can take substitutions. For example the option &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>path =
	/tmp/%u</em></span></span>&#8221; is interpreted as &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>path = 
	/tmp/john</em></span></span>&#8221; if the user connected with the username john.</p><p>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below, 
	but there are some general substitutions which apply whenever they 
	might be relevant. These are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">%U</span></dt><dd><p>session username (the username that the client 
		wanted, not necessarily the same as the one they got).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%G</span></dt><dd><p>primary group name of %U.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%h</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet hostname that Samba is running 
		on.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%m</span></dt><dd><p>the NetBIOS name of the client machine 
		(very useful).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%L</span></dt><dd><p>the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you 
		to change your config based on what the client calls you. Your 
		server can have a &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>dual personality</em></span></span>&#8221;.</p><p>This parameter is not available when Samba listens
                on port 445, as clients no longer send this information.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%M</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet name of the client machine.
		</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%R</span></dt><dd><p>the selected protocol level after 
		protocol negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS, 
		LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%d</span></dt><dd><p>The process id of the current server
		process.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%a</span></dt><dd><p>the architecture of the remote
		machine. Only some are recognized, and those may not be 
		100% reliable. It currently recognizes Samba, Windows for Workgroups, Windows 95,
		Windows NT and Windows 2000. Anything else will be known as 
		&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>UNKNOWN</em></span></span>&#8221;. If it gets it wrong sending a level 
		3 log to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org
		</a> should allow it to be fixed.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%I</span></dt><dd><p>The IP address of the client machine.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%T</span></dt><dd><p>the current date and time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%D</span></dt><dd><p>Name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%$(<i class="replaceable"><tt>envvar</tt></i>)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the environment variable
		<i class="replaceable"><tt>envar</tt></i>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>The following substitutes apply only to some configuration options (only those 
	that are used when a connection has been established):</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">%S</span></dt><dd><p>the name of the current service, if any.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%P</span></dt><dd><p>the root directory of the current service, 
		if any.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%u</span></dt><dd><p>username of the current service, if any.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%g</span></dt><dd><p>primary group name of %u.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%H</span></dt><dd><p>the home directory of the user given 
		by %u.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%N</span></dt><dd><p>the name of your NIS home directory server.  
		This is obtained from your NIS auto.map entry.  If you have 
		not compiled Samba with the <span class="emphasis"><em>--with-automount</em></span> 
		option, this value will be the same as %L.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%p</span></dt><dd><p>the path of the service's home directory, 
		obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. The NIS auto.map entry 
		is split up as &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>%N:%p</em></span></span>&#8221;.</p></dd></dl></div><p>There are some quite creative things that can be done 
	with these substitutions and other <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> options.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="NAMEMANGLINGSECT"></a><h2>NAME MANGLING</h2><p>Samba supports &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>name mangling</em></span></span>&#8221; so that DOS and 
	Windows clients can use files that don't conform to the 8.3 format. 
	It can also be set to adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.</p><p>There are several options that control the way mangling is 
	performed, and they are grouped here rather than listed separately. 
	For the defaults look at the output of the testparm program. </p><p>All of these options can be set separately for each service 
	(or globally, of course). </p><p>The options are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">case sensitive = yes/no/auto</span></dt><dd><p>controls whether filenames are case sensitive. If 
		they aren't, Samba must do a filename search and match on passed 
		names. The default setting of auto allows clients that support case
		sensitive filenames (Linux CIFSVFS and smbclient 3.0.5 and above currently)
		to tell the Samba server on a per-packet basis that they wish to access
		the file system in a case-sensitive manner (to support UNIX case sensitive
		semantics). No Windows or DOS system supports case-sensitive filename so
		setting this option to auto is that same as setting it to no for them.
		Default <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">default case = upper/lower</span></dt><dd><p>controls what the default case is for new 
		filenames. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>lower</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls whether new files are created with the 
		case that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the 
		&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>default</em></span></span>&#8221; case. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>.
		</p></dd><dt><span class="term">short preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls if new files which conform to 8.3 syntax,
		that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are created 
		upper case, or if they are forced to be the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>default</em></span></span>&#8221; 
		case. This option can be used with &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>preserve case = yes</em></span></span>&#8221; 
		to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short names 
		are lowercased. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>By default, Samba 3.0 has the same semantics as a Windows 
	NT server, in that it is case insensitive but case preserving.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="VALIDATIONSECT"></a><h2>NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</h2><p>There are a number of ways in which a user can connect 
	to a service. The server uses the following steps in determining 
	if it will allow a connection to a specified service. If all the 
	steps fail, the connection request is rejected.  However, if one of the 
	steps succeeds, the following steps are not checked.</p><p>If the service is marked &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>guest only = yes</em></span></span>&#8221; and the
	server is running with share-level security (&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>security = share</em></span></span>&#8221;,
	steps 1 to 5 are skipped.</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>If the client has passed a username/password 
		pair and that username/password pair is validated by the UNIX 
		system's password programs, the connection is made as that 
		username. This includes the 
		\\server\service%<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> method of passing 
		a username.</p></li><li><p>If the client has previously registered a username 
		with the system and now supplies a correct password for that 
		username, the connection is allowed.</p></li><li><p>The client's NetBIOS name and any previously 
		used usernames are checked against the supplied password. If 
		they match, the connection is allowed as the corresponding 
		user.</p></li><li><p>If the client has previously validated a
		username/password pair with the server and the client has passed 
		the validation token, that username is used. </p></li><li><p>If a &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>user = </em></span></span>&#8221; field is given in the
		<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file for the service and the client 
		has supplied a password, and that password matches (according to 
		the UNIX system's password checking) with one of the usernames 
		from the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>user =</em></span></span>&#8221; field, the connection is made as 
		the username in the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>user =</em></span></span>&#8221; line. If one 
		of the usernames in the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>user =</em></span></span>&#8221; list begins with a
		&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>@</em></span></span>&#8221;, that name expands to a list of names in 
		the group of the same name.</p></li><li><p>If the service is a guest service, a 
		connection is made as the username given in the &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>guest 
		account =</em></span></span>&#8221; for the service, irrespective of the 
		supplied password.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2491474"></a><h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a name="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a>abort shutdown script (G)</span></dt><dd><p><span class="emphasis"><em>This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</em></span>
	This a full path name to a script called by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that
	should stop a shutdown procedure issued by the <a href="#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i></a>.</p><p>This command will be run as user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>abort shutdown script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>abort shutdown script</tt></i> = /sbin/shutdown -c
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ACLCOMPATIBILITY"></a>acl compatibility (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies what OS ACL semantics should 
	be compatible with. Possible values are <span class="emphasis"><em>winnt</em></span> for Windows NT 4, 
	<span class="emphasis"><em>win2k</em></span> for Windows 2000 and above and <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>.
	If you specify <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, the value for this parameter 
	will be based upon the version of the client. There should 
	be no reason to change this parameter from the default.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>acl compatibility</tt></i> = Auto
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>acl compatibility</tt></i> = win2k
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"></a>add group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run
	<span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
	when a new group is requested. It will expand any <i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> to the group name passed. This
	script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT
	domain administration tools. The script is free to create a
	group with an arbitrary name to circumvent unix group name
	restrictions. In that case the script must print the numeric gid
	of the created group on stdout.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDMACHINESCRIPT"></a>add machine script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will  be run by
	<a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a machine is added
	to it's domain using the administrator username and password
	method. </p><p>This option is only required when using sam back-ends tied
	to the Unix uid method of RID calculation such as smbpasswd. 
	This option is only available in Samba 3.0.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> = /usr/sbin/adduser -n -g machines -c Machine -d /dev/null -s /bin/false %u
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"></a>addprinter command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing
    support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, The MS Add
    Printer Wizard (APW) icon is now also available in the 
    "Printers..." folder displayed a share listing.  The APW
    allows for printers to be add remotely to a Samba or Windows 
    NT/2000 print server.</p><p>For a Samba host this means that the printer must be 
    physically added to the underlying printing system.  The <i class="parameter"><tt>add 
    printer command</tt></i> defines a script to be run which 
    will perform the necessary operations for adding the printer
    to the print system and to add the appropriate service definition 
    to the  <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in order that it can be 
    shared by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i> is
    automatically invoked with the following parameter (in 
    order):</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>share name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>port name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>driver name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>location</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>Windows 9x driver location</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>All parameters are filled in from the PRINTER_INFO_2 structure sent 
    by the Windows NT/2000 client with one exception.  The "Windows 9x
    driver location" parameter is included for backwards compatibility
    only.  The remaining fields in the structure are generated from answers
    to the APW questions.</p><p>Once the <i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i> has 
    been executed, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will reparse the <tt class="filename">
    smb.conf</tt> to determine if the share defined by the APW
    exists.  If the sharename is still invalid, then <span><b class="command">smbd
    </b></span> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</p><p>
    The "add printer command" program can output a single line of text,
    which Samba will set as the port the new printer is connected to. 
    If this line isn't output, Samba won't reload its printer shares.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/addprinter
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDSHARECOMMAND"></a>add share command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically 
	add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager.  The 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i> is used to define an 
	external program or script which will add a new service definition 
	to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.  In order to successfully 
	execute the <i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i>, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span>
	requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e. 
	uid == 0).
	</p><p>
	When executed, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will automatically invoke the 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i> with four parameters.
	</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>configFile</tt></i> - the location 
			of the global <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. 
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>shareName</tt></i> - the name of the new 
			share.
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>pathName</tt></i> - path to an **existing**
			directory on disk.
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> - comment string to associate 
			with the new share.
			</p></li></ul></div><p>
	This parameter is only used for add file shares.  To add printer shares, 
	see the <a href="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter 
	command</tt></i></a>.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i> = /usr/local/bin/addshare
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDUSERSCRIPT"></a>add user script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will 
	be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> under special circumstances described below.</p><p>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are 
	created for all users accessing files on this server. For sites 
	that use Windows NT account databases as their primary user database 
	creating these users and keeping the user list in sync with the 
	Windows NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows smbd to create the required UNIX users 
	<span class="emphasis"><em>ON DEMAND</em></span> when a user accesses the Samba server.</p><p>In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be set to <i class="parameter"><tt>security = share</tt></i>
	and <i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i>
	must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX 
	user given one argument of <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i>, which expands into 
	the UNIX user name to create.</p><p>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server, 
	at login (session setup in the SMB protocol) time, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> and 
	attempts to authenticate the given user with the given password. If the 
	authentication succeeds then <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> 
	attempts to find a UNIX user in the UNIX password database to map the 
	Windows user into. If this lookup fails, and <i class="parameter"><tt>add user script
	</tt></i> is set then <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will
	call the specified script <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>, expanding 
	any <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> argument to be the user name to create.</p><p>If this script successfully creates the user then <span><b class="command">smbd
	</b></span> will continue on as though the UNIX user
	already existed. In this way, UNIX users are dynamically created to
	match existing Windows NT accounts.</p><p>See also <a href="#SECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	security</tt></i></a>, <a href="#PASSWORDSERVER">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i></a>, 
	<a href="#DELETEUSERSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user 
	script</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/bin/add_user %u
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"></a>add user to group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Full path to the script that will be called when 
	a user is added to a group using the Windows NT domain administration 
	tools. It will be run by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>	<span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>. 
	Any <i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> will be replaced with the group name and 
	any <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> will be replaced with the user name.
	</p><p>Note that the <span><b class="command">adduser</b></span> command used in the example below does 
		not support the used syntax on all systems. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add user to group script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>add user to group script</tt></i> = /usr/sbin/adduser %u %g
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADMINUSERS"></a>admin users (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users who will be granted 
    administrative privileges on the share. This means that they 
    will do all file operations as the super-user (root).</p><p>You should use this option very carefully, as any user in 
    this list will be able to do anything they like on the share, 
	irrespective of file permissions.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i> = jason
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AFSSHARE"></a>afs share (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether special AFS features are enabled
	for this share. If enabled, it assumes that the directory exported via
	the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter is a local AFS import. The
	special AFS features include the attempt to hand-craft an AFS token
	if you enabled --with-fake-kaserver in configure.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>afs share</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AFSUSERNAMEMAP"></a>afs username map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If you are using the fake kaserver AFS feature, you might
	want to hand-craft the usernames you are creating tokens for.
	For example this is necessary if you have users from several domain
	in your AFS Protection Database. One possible scheme to code users
	as DOMAIN+User as it is done by winbind with the + as a separator.
	</p><p>The mapped user name must contain the cell name to log into,
	so without setting this parameter there will be no token.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>afs username map</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>afs username map</tt></i> = %u@afs.samba.org
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"></a>algorithmic rid base (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This determines how Samba will use its
    algorithmic mapping from uids/gid to the RIDs needed to construct
    NT Security Identifiers.
    </p><p>Setting this option to a larger value could be useful to sites
    transitioning from WinNT and Win2k, as existing user and 
    group rids would otherwise clash with sytem users etc. 
    </p><p>All UIDs and GIDs must be able to be resolved into SIDs for  
    the correct operation of ACLs on the server.  As such the algorithmic
    mapping can't be 'turned off', but pushing it 'out of the way' should
    resolve the issues.  Users and groups can then be assigned 'low' RIDs
    in arbitary-rid supporting backends.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>algorithmic rid base</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>algorithmic rid base</tt></i> = 100000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"></a>allow trusted domains (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option only takes effect when the <a href="#SECURITY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a> option is set to 
    <tt class="constant">server</tt> or <tt class="constant">domain</tt>.  
    If it is set to no, then attempts to connect to a resource from 
    a domain or workgroup other than the one which smbd is running 
    in will fail, even if that domain is trusted by the remote server 
    doing the authentication.</p><p>This is useful if you only want your Samba server to 
    serve resources to users in the domain it is a member of. As 
    an example, suppose that there are two domains DOMA and DOMB.  DOMB 
    is trusted by DOMA, which contains the Samba server.  Under normal 
    circumstances, a user with an account in DOMB can then access the 
    resources of a UNIX account with the same account name on the 
    Samba server even if they do not have an account in DOMA.  This 
    can make implementing a security boundary difficult.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>allow trusted domains</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ANNOUNCEAS"></a>announce as (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies what type of server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse 
    list. By default this is set to Windows NT. The valid options 
    are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"), 
    "NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server, 
    Windows NT Workstation, Windows 95 and Windows for Workgroups 
    respectively. Do not change this parameter unless you have a 
    specific need to stop Samba appearing as an NT server as this 
    may prevent Samba servers from participating as browser servers 
	correctly.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>announce as</tt></i> = NT Server
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>announce as</tt></i> = Win95
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ANNOUNCEVERSION"></a>announce version (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies the major and minor version numbers 
    that nmbd will use when announcing itself as a server. The default 
    is 4.9.  Do not change this parameter unless you have a specific 
	need to set a Samba server to be a downlevel server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>announce version</tt></i> = 4.9
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>announce version</tt></i> = 2.0
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AUTHMETHODS"></a>auth methods (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the administrator to chose what
    authentication methods <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will use when authenticating
    a user.  This option defaults to sensible values based on <a href="#SECURITY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a>.  This should be considered
    a developer option and used only in rare circumstances.  In the majority (if not all)
    of production servers, the default setting should be adequate.</p><p>Each entry in the list attempts to authenticate the user in turn, until
    the user authenticates.  In practice only one method will ever actually 
    be able to complete the authentication.
    </p><p>Possible options include <tt class="constant">guest</tt> (anonymous access), 
    <tt class="constant">sam</tt> (lookups in local list of accounts based on netbios 
    name or domain name), <tt class="constant">winbind</tt> (relay authentication requests
    for remote users through winbindd), <tt class="constant">ntdomain</tt> (pre-winbindd 
    method of authentication for remote domain users; deprecated in favour of winbind method), 
    <tt class="constant">trustdomain</tt> (authenticate trusted users by contacting the 
	remote DC directly from smbd; deprecated in favour of winbind method).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> = guest sam winbind
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AVAILABLE"></a>available (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>available = no</tt></i>, then <span class="emphasis"><em>ALL</em></span> 
	attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures are 
	logged.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>available</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BINDINTERFACESONLY"></a>bind interfaces only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This global parameter allows the Samba admin 
        to limit what interfaces on a machine will serve SMB requests. It 
        affects file service <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and name service <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> in a slightly different ways.</p><p>For name service it causes <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to bind 
	to ports 137 and 138 on the interfaces listed in 
        the <a href="#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter. <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> also 
        binds to the "all addresses" interface (0.0.0.0) 
	on ports 137 and 138 for the purposes of reading broadcast messages. 
	If this option is not set then <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> will service 
	name requests on all of these sockets. If <i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces
	only</tt></i> is set then <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> will check the 
	source address of any packets coming in on the broadcast sockets 
	and discard any that don't match the broadcast addresses of the 
	interfaces in the <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> parameter list. 
	As unicast packets are received on the other sockets it allows 
	<span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to refuse to serve names to machines that 
	send packets that arrive through any interfaces not listed in the
	<i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> list.  IP Source address spoofing
	does defeat this simple check, however, so it must not be used
	seriously as a security feature for <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span>.</p><p>For file service it causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to bind only to the interface list 
	given in the <a href="#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter. This 
        restricts the networks that <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will serve 
        to packets coming in those interfaces.  Note that you should not use this parameter 
        for machines that are serving PPP or other intermittent or non-broadcast network 
	interfaces as it will not cope with non-permanent interfaces.</p><p>If <i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> is set then 
	unless the network address <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> is added 
	to the <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> parameter 
        list <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> may not work as expected due 
        to the reasons covered below.</p><p>To change a users SMB password, the <span><b class="command">smbpasswd</b></span>
	by default connects to the <span class="emphasis"><em>localhost - 127.0.0.1</em></span> 
	address as an SMB client to issue the password change request. If 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> is set then unless the 
	network address <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> is added to the
	<i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> parameter list then <span><b class="command">
	smbpasswd</b></span> will fail to connect in it's default mode. 
	<span><b class="command">smbpasswd</b></span> can be forced to use the primary IP interface 
	of the local host by using its <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>	<i class="parameter"><tt>-r <i class="replaceable"><tt>remote machine</tt></i></tt></i>
	parameter, with <i class="replaceable"><tt>remote machine</tt></i> set 
	to the IP name of the primary interface of the local host.</p><p>The <span><b class="command">swat</b></span> status page tries to connect with
	<span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> and <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> at the address 
	<span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> to determine if they are running.  
	Not adding <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span>  will cause <span><b class="command">
	smbd</b></span> and <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to always show
	"not running" even if they really are.  This can prevent <span><b class="command">
	swat</b></span> from starting/stopping/restarting <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span>
	and <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BLOCKINGLOCKS"></a>blocking locks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior 
	of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when given a request by a client 
	to obtain a byte range lock on a region of an open file, and the 
	request has a time limit associated with it.</p><p>If this parameter is set and the lock range requested 
	cannot be immediately satisfied, samba will internally 
	queue the lock request, and periodically attempt to obtain 
	the lock until the timeout period expires.</p><p>If this parameter is set to <tt class="constant">no</tt>, then 
	samba will behave as previous versions of Samba would and 
	will fail the lock request immediately if the lock range 
	cannot be obtained.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>blocking locks</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BLOCKSIZE"></a>block size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when reporting disk free 
    sizes. By default, this reports a disk block size of 1024 bytes.
    </p><p>Changing this parameter may have some effect on the
    efficiency of client writes, this is not yet confirmed. This
    parameter was added to allow advanced administrators to change
    it (usually to a higher value) and test the effect it has on
    client write performance without re-compiling the code. As this
    is an experimental option it may be removed in a future release.
    </p><p>Changing this option does not change the disk free reporting
    size, just the block size unit reported to the client.
    </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BROWSABLE"></a>browsable</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for browseable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BROWSEABLE"></a>browseable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether this share is seen in 
	the list of available shares in a net view and in the browse list.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BROWSELIST"></a>browse list (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will serve a browse list to 
	a client doing a <span><b class="command">NetServerEnum</b></span> call. Normally 
	set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. You should never need to change 
	this.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CASESIGNAMES"></a>casesignames</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for case sensitive.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CASESENSITIVE"></a>case sensitive (S)</span></dt><dd><p>See the discussion in the section <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"></a>change notify timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This SMB allows a client to tell a server to 
    "watch" a particular directory for any changes and only reply to
    the SMB request when a change has occurred. Such constant scanning of
    a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon only performs such a scan 
    on each requested directory once every <i class="parameter"><tt>change notify 
    timeout</tt></i> seconds.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>change notify timeout</tt></i> = 60
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>change notify timeout</tt></i> = 300
# Would change the scan time to every 5 minutes.
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"></a>change share command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically 
	add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager.  The 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i> is used to define an 
	external program or script which will modify an existing service definition 
	in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.  In order to successfully 
	execute the <i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i>, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span>
	requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e. 
	uid == 0).
	</p><p>
	When executed, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will automatically invoke the 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i> with four parameters.
	</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>configFile</tt></i> - the location 
			of the global <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. 
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>shareName</tt></i> - the name of the new 
			share.
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>pathName</tt></i> - path to an **existing**
			directory on disk.
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> - comment string to associate 
			with the new share.
			</p></li></ul></div><p>
	This parameter is only used modify existing file shares definitions.  To modify 
	printer shares, use the "Printers..." folder as seen when browsing the Samba host.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i> = /usr/local/bin/addshare
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTLANMANAUTH"></a>client lanman auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> and other samba client
    tools will attempt to authenticate itself to servers using the
    weaker LANMAN password hash. If disabled, only server which support NT 
    password hashes (e.g. Windows NT/2000, Samba, etc... but not 
    Windows 95/98) will be able to be connected from the Samba client.</p><p>The LANMAN encrypted response is easily broken, due to it's
    case-insensitive nature, and the choice of algorithm.  Clients
    without Windows 95/98 servers are advised to disable
    this option.  </p><p>Disabling this option will also disable the <span><b class="command">client plaintext auth</b></span> option</p><p>Likewise, if the <span><b class="command">client ntlmv2
    auth</b></span> parameter is enabled, then only NTLMv2 logins will be
    attempted.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client lanman auth</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTNTLMV2AUTH"></a>client ntlmv2 auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
    authenticate itself to servers using the NTLMv2 encrypted password
    response.</p><p>If enabled, only an NTLMv2 and LMv2 response (both much more
    secure than earlier versions) will be sent.  Many servers
    (including NT4 &lt; SP4, Win9x and Samba 2.2) are not compatible with
    NTLMv2.  </p><p>Similarly, if enabled, NTLMv1, <span><b class="command">client lanman auth</b></span> and <span><b class="command">client plaintext auth</b></span>
    authentication will be disabled.  This also disables share-level 
    authentication. </p><p>If disabled, an NTLM response (and possibly a LANMAN response)
    will be sent by the client, depending on the value of <span><b class="command">client lanman auth</b></span>.  </p><p>Note that some sites (particularly
    those following 'best practice' security polices) only allow NTLMv2
	responses, and not the weaker LM or NTLM.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client ntlmv2 auth</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTPLAINTEXTAUTH"></a>client plaintext auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether a client should send a plaintext 
		password if the server does not support encrypted passwords.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client plaintext auth</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTSCHANNEL"></a>client schannel (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the client offers or even
    demands the use of the netlogon schannel.
    <i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel = no</tt></i> does not
    offer the schannel, <i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel =
    auto</tt></i> offers the schannel but does not
    enforce it, and <i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel =
    yes</tt></i> denies access if the server is not
	able to speak netlogon schannel. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel</tt></i> = auto
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTSIGNING"></a>client signing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the client offers or requires
    the server it talks to to use SMB signing. Possible values 
    are <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>mandatory</em></span> 
    and <span class="emphasis"><em>disabled</em></span>. 
    </p><p>When set to auto, SMB signing is offered, but not enforced. 
    When set to mandatory, SMB signing is required and if set 
	to disabled, SMB signing is not offered either.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client signing</tt></i> = auto
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTUSESPNEGO"></a>client use spnego (G)</span></dt><dd><p> This variable controls whether Samba clients will try 
    to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with 
    supporting servers (including WindowsXP, Windows2000 and Samba
    3.0) to agree upon an authentication
    mechanism.  This enables Kerberos authentication in particular.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>client use spnego</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COMMENT"></a>comment (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a text field that is seen next to a share 
	when a client does a queries the server, either via the network 
	neighborhood or via <span><b class="command">net view</b></span> to list what shares 
	are available.</p><p>If you want to set the string that is displayed next to the 
	machine name then see the <a href="#SERVERSTRING"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	server string</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = 
# No comment
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Fred's Files
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CONFIGFILE"></a>config file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This allows you to override the config file 
	to use, instead of the default (usually <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). 
	There is a chicken and egg problem here as this option is set 
	in the config file!</p><p>For this reason, if the name of the config file has changed 
	when the parameters are loaded then it will reload them from 
	the new config file.</p><p>This option takes the usual substitutions, which can 
	be very useful.</p><p>If the config file doesn't exist then it won't be loaded 
	(allowing you to special case the config files of just a few 
	clients).</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>config file</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COPY"></a>copy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows you to "clone" service 
	entries. The specified service is simply duplicated under the 
	current service's name. Any parameters specified in the current 
	section will override those in the section being copied.</p><p>This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and 
	create similar services easily. Note that the service being 
	copied must occur earlier in the configuration file than the 
	service doing the copying.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>copy</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>copy</tt></i> = otherservice
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CREATEMODE"></a>create mode</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for create mask.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CREATEMASK"></a>create mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>When a file is created, the necessary permissions are 
    calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX 
    permissions, and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed 
    with this parameter. This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise 
    MASK for the UNIX modes of a file. Any bit <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> 
    set here will be removed from the modes set on a file when it is 
    created.</p><p>The default value of this parameter removes the 
    'group' and 'other' write and execute bits from the UNIX modes.</p><p>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created 
    from this parameter with the value of the <a href="#FORCECREATEMODE">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i></a>
    parameter which is set to 000 by default.</p><p>This parameter does not affect directory modes. See the 
    parameter <a href="#DIRECTORYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mode
    </tt></i></a> for details.</p><p>Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
    set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
    a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <a href="#SECURITYMASK">
		<i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> = 0744
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> = 0775
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CSCPOLICY"></a>csc policy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This stands for <span class="emphasis"><em>client-side caching 
	policy</em></span>, and specifies how clients capable of offline
	caching will cache the files in the share. The valid values
	are: manual, documents, programs, disable.</p><p>These values correspond to those used on Windows servers.</p><p>For example, shares containing roaming profiles can have
	offline caching disabled using <span><b class="command">csc policy = disable</b></span>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i> = manual
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i> = programs
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CUPSOPTIONS"></a>cups options (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only applicable if <a href="#PRINTING"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i></a> is 
    set to <tt class="constant">cups</tt>.  Its value is a free form string of options
    passed directly to the cups library.  
    </p><p>You can pass any generic print option known to CUPS (as listed
   in the CUPS "Software Users' Manual").  You can also pass any printer
   specific option (as listed in "lpoptions -d printername -l")
   valid for the target queue.</p><p>You should set this parameter to <tt class="constant">raw</tt> if your CUPS server 
   <tt class="filename">error_log</tt> file contains messages such as
   "Unsupported format 'application/octet-stream'" when printing from a Windows client 
   through Samba.  It is no longer necessary to enable
   system wide raw printing in <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.{convs,types}</tt>.
   </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>cups options</tt></i> = ""
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>cups options</tt></i> = "raw,media=a4,job-sheets=secret,secret"
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CUPSSERVER"></a>cups server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only applicable if <a href="#PRINTING"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i></a> is 
    set to <tt class="constant">cups</tt>.
    </p><p>If set, this option overrides the ServerName option in the CUPS
   <tt class="filename">client.conf</tt>. This is necessary if you have virtual
   samba servers that connect to different CUPS daemons.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>cups server</tt></i> = ""
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>cups server</tt></i> = MYCUPSSERVER
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEADTIME"></a>deadtime (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer) 
    represents the number of minutes of inactivity before a connection 
    is considered dead, and it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes 
    effect if the number of open files is zero.</p><p>This is useful to stop a server's resources being 
    exhausted by a large number of inactive connections.</p><p>Most clients have an auto-reconnect feature when a 
    connection is broken so in most cases this parameter should be 
    transparent to users.</p><p>Using this parameter with a timeout of a few minutes 
    is recommended for most systems.</p><p>A deadtime of zero indicates that no auto-disconnection 
		should be performed.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>deadtime</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>deadtime</tt></i> = 15
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"></a>debug hires timestamp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages 
    are needed with a resolution of higher that seconds, this 
    boolean parameter adds microsecond resolution to the timestamp 
    message header when turned on.</p><p>Note that the parameter <a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    debug timestamp</tt></i></a> must be on for this to have an 
    effect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>debug hires timestamp</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGPID"></a>debug pid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When using only one log file for more then one  forked
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>-process there may be hard to
    follow which process  outputs which message. This boolean parameter
    is adds the process-id to the timestamp message headers in the
    logfile when turned on.</p><p>Note that the parameter <a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    debug timestamp</tt></i></a> must be on for this to have an 
	effect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>debug pid</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMESTAMPLOGS"></a>timestamp logs</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for debug timestamp.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"></a>debug timestamp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Samba debug log messages are timestamped 
    by default. If you are running at a high <a href="#DEBUGLEVEL">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i></a> these timestamps
    can be distracting. This boolean parameter allows timestamping 
    to be turned off.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>debug timestamp</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGUID"></a>debug uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime 
    run as the connected user, this boolean parameter inserts the 
    current euid, egid, uid and gid to the timestamp message headers 
    in the log file if turned on.</p><p>Note that the parameter <a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    debug timestamp</tt></i></a> must be on for this to have an 
    effect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>debug uid</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULTCASE"></a>default case (S)</span></dt><dd><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">
	NAME MANGLING</a>. Also note the <a href="#SHORTPRESERVECASE">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>default case</tt></i> = lower
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULTDEVMODE"></a>default devmode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only applicable to <a href="#PRINTOK">printable</a> services.
    When smbd is serving Printer Drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients, each printer on the Samba
    server has a Device Mode which defines things such as paper size and
    orientation and duplex settings.  The device mode can only correctly be
    generated by the printer driver itself (which can only be executed on a
    Win32 platform).  Because smbd is unable to execute the driver code
    to generate the device mode, the default behavior is to set this field
    to NULL.
    </p><p>Most problems with serving printer drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients
    can be traced to a problem with the generated device mode.  Certain drivers
    will do things such as crashing the client's Explorer.exe with a NULL devmode.
    However, other printer drivers can cause the client's spooler service
    (spoolsv.exe) to die if the devmode was not created by the driver itself
    (i.e. smbd generates a default devmode).
    </p><p>This parameter should be used with care and tested with the printer
    driver in question.  It is better to leave the device mode to NULL
    and let the Windows client set the correct values.  Because drivers do not
    do this all the time, setting <span><b class="command">default devmode = yes</b></span>
    will instruct smbd to generate a default one.
    </p><p>For more information on Windows NT/2k printing and Device Modes,
    see the <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">MSDN documentation</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>default devmode</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULT"></a>default</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for default service.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULTSERVICE"></a>default service (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a service
	which will be connected to if the service actually requested cannot
	be found. Note that the square brackets are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span>
	given in the parameter value (see example below).</p><p>There is no default value for this parameter. If this 
	parameter is not given, attempting to connect to a nonexistent 
	service results in an error.</p><p>Typically the default service would be a <a href="#GUESTOK">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></a>, <a href="#READONLY">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>read-only</tt></i></a> service.</p><p>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed 
	to equal that of the requested service, this is very useful as it 
	allows you to use macros like <i class="parameter"><tt>%S</tt></i> to make 
	a wildcard service.</p><p>Note also that any "_" characters in the name of the service 
	used in the default service will get mapped to a "/". This allows for
	interesting things.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>default service</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>default service</tt></i> = pub
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFERSHARINGVIOLATIONS"></a>defer sharing violations (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
	Windows allows specifying how a file will be shared with 
	other processes when it is opened. Sharing violations occur when 
	a file is opened by a different process using options that violate 
	the share settings specified by other processes. This parameter causes
	smbd to act as a Windows server does, and defer returning a "sharing
	violation" error message for up to one second, allowing the client
	to close the file causing the violation in the meantime.
	</p><p>Unix by default does not have this behaviour.</p><p>
	There should be no reason to turn off this parameter, as it is
	designed to enable Samba to more correctly emulate Windows.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>defer sharing violations</tt></i> = True
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"></a>delete group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will 
	be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a group is requested to be deleted. 
	It will expand any <i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> to the group name passed.  
	This script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT domain administration tools.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete group script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"></a>deleteprinter command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printer
    support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, it is now 
    possible to delete printer at run time by issuing the 
    DeletePrinter() RPC call.</p><p>For a Samba host this means that the printer must be 
    physically deleted from underlying printing system.  The <i class="parameter"><tt>
    deleteprinter command</tt></i> defines a script to be run which 
    will perform the necessary operations for removing the printer
    from the print system and from <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.
    </p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> is 
    automatically called with only one parameter: <i class="parameter"><tt>
    "printer name"</tt></i>.</p><p>Once the <i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> has 
    been executed, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will reparse the <tt class="filename">
    smb.conf</tt> to associated printer no longer exists.  
    If the sharename is still valid, then <span><b class="command">smbd
</b></span> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/removeprinter
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEREADONLY"></a>delete readonly (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted.  
	This is not normal DOS semantics, but is allowed by UNIX.</p><p>This option may be useful for running applications such 
	as rcs, where UNIX file ownership prevents changing file 
	permissions, and DOS semantics prevent deletion of a read only file.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete readonly</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETESHARECOMMAND"></a>delete share command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically 
	add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager.  The 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i> is used to define an 
	external program or script which will remove an existing service 
	definition from <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.  In order to successfully 
	execute the <i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i>, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span>
	requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e. 
	uid == 0).
	</p><p>
	When executed, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will automatically invoke the 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i> with two parameters.
	</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>configFile</tt></i> - the location 
			of the global <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. 
			</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>shareName</tt></i> - the name of 
			the existing service.
			</p></li></ul></div><p>
	This parameter is only used to remove file shares.  To delete printer shares, 
	see the <a href="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter 
	command</tt></i></a>.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i> = /usr/local/bin/delshare
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"></a>delete user from group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Full path to the script that will be called when 
	a user is removed from a group using the Windows NT domain administration 
	tools. It will be run by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>. 
	Any <i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> will be replaced with the group name and 
	any <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> will be replaced with the user name.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user from group script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user from group script</tt></i> = /usr/sbin/deluser %u %g
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"></a>delete user script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will 
	be run by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when managing users 
	with remote RPC (NT) tools.
	</p><p>This script is called when a remote client removes a user
	from the server, normally using 'User Manager for Domains' or
	<span><b class="command">rpcclient</b></span>.</p><p>This script should delete the given UNIX username.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user script</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/bin/del_user %u
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEVETOFILES"></a>delete veto files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used when Samba is attempting to 
	delete a directory that contains one or more vetoed directories 
	(see the <a href="#VETOFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></a>
	option).  If this option is set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> (the default) then if a vetoed 
	directory contains any non-vetoed files or directories then the 
	directory delete will fail. This is usually what you want.</p><p>If this option is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then Samba 
	will attempt to recursively delete any files and directories within 
	the vetoed directory. This can be useful for integration with file 
	serving systems such as NetAtalk which create meta-files within 
	directories you might normally veto DOS/Windows users from seeing 
	(e.g. <tt class="filename">.AppleDouble</tt>)</p><p>Setting <span><b class="command">delete veto files = yes</b></span> allows these 
	directories to be  transparently deleted when the parent directory 
	is deleted (so long as the user has permissions to do so).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>delete veto files</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DFREECOMMAND"></a>dfree command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>dfree command</tt></i> setting
	should only be used on systems where a problem occurs with the
	internal disk space calculations. This has been known to happen
	with Ultrix, but may occur with other operating systems. The
	symptom that was seen was an error of "Abort Retry
	Ignore" at the end of each directory listing.</p><p>This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to
	calculate the total disk space and amount available with an external
	routine. The example below gives a possible script that might fulfill
	this function.</p><p>The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating 
	a directory in the filesystem being queried. This will typically consist
	of the string <tt class="filename">./</tt>. The script should return two 
	integers in ASCII. The first should be the total disk space in blocks, 
	and the second should be the number of available blocks. An optional 
	third return value can give the block size in bytes. The default 
	blocksize is 1024 bytes.</p><p>Note: Your script should <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be setuid or 
	setgid and should be owned by (and writeable only by) root!</p><p>Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:</p><pre class="programlisting"> 
#!/bin/sh
df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}'
</pre><p>or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):</p><pre class="programlisting"> 
#!/bin/sh
/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}'
</pre><p>Note that you may have to replace the command names with full path names on some systems.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dfree command</tt></i> = 
# By default internal routines for 
		determining the disk capacity and remaining space will be used.
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dfree command</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/bin/dfree
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYMODE"></a>directory mode</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for directory mask.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYMASK"></a>directory mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is the octal modes which are 
    used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX 
    directories.</p><p>When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are 
    calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX permissions, 
    and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed with this 
    parameter. This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise MASK for 
    the UNIX modes of a directory. Any bit <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> set 
    here will be removed from the modes set on a directory when it is 
    created.</p><p>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group' 
    and 'other' write bits from the UNIX mode, allowing only the 
    user who owns the directory to modify it.</p><p>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode 
    created from this parameter with the value of the <a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i></a> parameter. 
    This parameter is set to 000 by default (i.e. no extra mode bits are added).</p><p>Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
    set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
    a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <a href="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK">
		<i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i> = 0755
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i> = 0775
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"></a>directory security mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits 
    can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX 
    permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog 
    box.</p><p>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to 
    the changed permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in 
    this mask from being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this 
    mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is not allowed 
    to change.</p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to 0777
    meaning a user is allowed to modify all the user/group/world
    permissions on a directory.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access the 
    Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, 
    so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.  
    Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
	it as the default of <tt class="constant">0777</tt>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> = 0777
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> = 0700
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DISABLENETBIOS"></a>disable netbios (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Enabling this parameter will disable netbios support
    in Samba. Netbios is the only available form of browsing in 
    all windows versions except for 2000 and XP. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Clients that only support netbios won't be able to 
    see your samba server when netbios support is disabled.
	</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>disable netbios</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DISABLESPOOLSS"></a>disable spoolss (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Enabling this parameter will disable Samba's support
    for the SPOOLSS set of MS-RPC's and will yield identical behavior
    as Samba 2.0.x.  Windows NT/2000 clients will downgrade to using
    Lanman style printing commands. Windows 9x/ME will be uneffected by
    the parameter. However, this will also disable the ability to upload
    printer drivers to a Samba server via the Windows NT Add Printer
    Wizard or by using the NT printer properties dialog window.  It will
    also disable the capability of Windows NT/2000 clients to download
    print drivers from the Samba host upon demand.
    <span class="emphasis"><em>Be very careful about enabling this parameter.</em></span>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DISPLAYCHARSET"></a>display charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the charset that samba will use 
	to print messages to stdout and stderr and SWAT will use. 
	Should generally be the same as the <span><b class="command">unix charset</b></span>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i> = ASCII
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i> = UTF8
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DNSPROXY"></a>dns proxy (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> when acting as a WINS server and 
	finding that a NetBIOS name has not been registered, should treat the 
	NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS name and do a lookup with the DNS server 
	for that name on behalf of the name-querying client.</p><p>Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15 
	characters, so the DNS name (or DNS alias) can likewise only be 
	15 characters, maximum.</p><p><span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> spawns a second copy of itself to do the
	DNS name lookup requests, as doing a name lookup is a blocking 
	action.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dns proxy</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOMAINLOGONS"></a>domain logons (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, the Samba server will serve 
	Windows 95/98 Domain logons for the <a href="#WORKGROUP">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i></a> it is in. Samba 2.2
	has limited capability to act as a domain controller for Windows 
	NT 4 Domains.  For more details on setting up this feature see 
	the PDC chapter of the Samba HOWTO Collection.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOMAINMASTER"></a>domain master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Tell <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to enable WAN-wide browse list
	collation. Setting this option causes <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to
	claim a special domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies 
	it as a domain master browser for its given <a href="#WORKGROUP">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i></a>. Local master browsers 
	in the same <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> on broadcast-isolated 
	subnets will give this <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> their local browse lists, 
	and then ask <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> for a complete copy of the browse 
	list for the whole wide area network.  Browser clients will then contact 
	their local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list, 
	instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet.</p><p>Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be 
	able to claim this <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> specific special 
	NetBIOS name that identifies them as domain master browsers for 
	that <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> by default (i.e. there is no 
	way to prevent a Windows NT PDC from attempting to do this). This 
	means that if this parameter is set and <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> claims 
	the special name for a <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> before a Windows 
	NT PDC is able to do so then cross subnet browsing will behave 
	strangely and may fail.</p><p>If <a href="#DOMAINLOGONS"><span><b class="command">domain logons = yes</b></span>
	</a>, then the default behavior is to enable the <i class="parameter"><tt>domain 
	master</tt></i> parameter.  If <i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i> is 
	not enabled (the default setting), then neither will <i class="parameter"><tt>domain 
	master</tt></i> be enabled by default.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = auto
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DONTDESCEND"></a>dont descend (S)</span></dt><dd><p>There are certain directories on some systems 
	(e.g., the <tt class="filename">/proc</tt> tree under Linux) that are either not 
	of interest to clients or are infinitely deep (recursive). This 
	parameter allows you to specify a comma-delimited list of directories 
	that the server should always show as empty.</p><p>Note that Samba can be very fussy about the exact format 
	of the "dont descend" entries. For example you may need <tt class="filename">
	./proc</tt> instead of just <tt class="filename">/proc</tt>. 
	Experimentation is the best policy :-)  </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i> = /proc,/dev
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSCHARSET"></a>dos charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>DOS SMB clients assume the server has 
	the same charset as they do. This option specifies which 
	charset Samba should talk to DOS clients.
	</p><p>The default depends on which charsets you have installed. 
	Samba tries to use charset 850 but falls back to ASCII in 
	case it is not available. Run <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> to check the default on your system.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSFILEMODE"></a>dos filemode (S)</span></dt><dd><p> The default behavior in Samba is to provide 
	UNIX-like behavior where only the owner of a file/directory is 
	able to change the permissions on it.  However, this behavior
	is often confusing to  DOS/Windows users.  Enabling this parameter 
	allows a user who has write access to the file (by whatever 
	means) to modify the permissions on it.  Note that a user
	belonging to the group owning the file will not be allowed to
	change permissions if the group is only granted read access.
	Ownership of the file/directory is not changed, only the permissions 
	are modified.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filemode</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"></a>dos filetime resolution (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest 
	granularity on time resolution is two seconds. Setting this parameter 
	for a share causes Samba to round the reported time down to the 
	nearest two second boundary when a query call that requires one second 
	resolution is made to <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual 
	C++ when used against Samba shares. If oplocks are enabled on a 
	share, Visual C++ uses two different time reading calls to check if a 
	file has changed since it was last read. One of these calls uses a
	one-second granularity, the other uses a two second granularity. As
	the two second call rounds any odd second down, then if the file has a
	timestamp of an odd number of seconds then the two timestamps will not
	match and Visual C++ will keep reporting the file has changed. Setting
	this option causes the two timestamps to match, and Visual C++ is
	happy.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetime resolution</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSFILETIMES"></a>dos filetimes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a 
	file they can change the timestamp on it. Under POSIX semantics, 
	only the owner of the file or root may change the timestamp. By 
	default, Samba runs with POSIX semantics and refuses to change the 
	timestamp on a file if the user <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> is acting 
	on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option to <tt class="constant">
	yes</tt> allows DOS semantics and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will change the file 
timestamp as DOS requires.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetimes</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="EASUPPORT"></a>ea support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will allow clients to attempt to store OS/2 style Extended
    attributes on a share. In order to enable this parameter the underlying filesystem exported by
    the share must support extended attributes (such as provided on XFS and EXT3 on Linux, with the
    correct kernel patches). On Linux the filesystem must have been mounted with the mount
        option user_xattr in order for extended attributes to work, also
		extended attributes must be compiled into the Linux kernel.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ea support</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENABLERIDALGORITHM"></a>enable rid algorithm (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to control whether or not smbd in Samba 3.0 should fallback
	to the algorithm used by Samba 2.2 to generate user and group RIDs.  The longterm
	development goal is to remove the algorithmic mappings of RIDs altogether, but 
	this has proved to be difficult.  This parameter is mainly provided so that
	developers can turn the algorithm on and off and see what breaks.  This parameter
	should not be disabled by non-developers because certain features in Samba will fail 
	to work without it.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>enable rid algorithm</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"></a>encrypt passwords (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords 
    will be negotiated with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and 
    above and also Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords 
    unless a registry entry is changed. To use encrypted passwords in 
    Samba see the chapter "User Database" in the Samba HOWTO Collection.
    </p><p>
    MS Windows clients that expect Microsoft encrypted passwords and that
    do not have plain text password support enabled will be able to
    connect only to a Samba server that has encypted password support
    enabled and for which the user accounts have a valid encrypted password.
    Refer to the smbpasswd command man page for information regarding the
    creation of encrypted passwords for user accounts.
    </p><p>
    The use of plain text passwords is NOT advised as support for this feature
    is no longer maintained in Microsoft Windows products. If you want to use
    plain text passwords you must set this parameter to no.
    </p><p>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must either 
    have access to a local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file (see the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> program for information on how to set up 
    and maintain this file), or set the <a href="#SECURITY">security = [server|domain|ads]</a> parameter which 
    causes <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> to authenticate against another 
	server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENHANCEDBROWSING"></a>enhanced browsing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option enables a couple of enhancements to 
	cross-subnet browse propagation that have been added in Samba 
	but which are not standard in Microsoft implementations.  
	</p><p>The first enhancement to browse propagation consists of a regular
	wildcard query to a Samba WINS server for all Domain Master Browsers,
	followed by a browse synchronization with each of the returned
	DMBs. The second enhancement consists of a regular randomised browse
	synchronization with all currently known DMBs.</p><p>You may wish to disable this option if you have a problem with empty
	workgroups not disappearing from browse lists. Due to the restrictions
	of the browse protocols these enhancements can cause a empty workgroup
	to stay around forever which can be annoying.</p><p>In general you should leave this option enabled as it makes
	cross-subnet browse propagation much more reliable.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>enhanced browsing</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"></a>enumports command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign
    to UNIX hosts.  Under Windows NT/2000 print servers, a port
    is associated with a port monitor and generally takes the form of
    a local port (i.e. LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:) or a remote port
    (i.e. LPD Port Monitor, etc...).  By default, Samba has only one
    port defined--<tt class="constant">"Samba Printer Port"</tt>.  Under 
    Windows NT/2000, all printers must have a valid port name.  
    If you wish to have a list of ports displayed (<span><b class="command">smbd
    </b></span> does not use a port name for anything) other than 
    the default <tt class="constant">"Samba Printer Port"</tt>, you 
    can define <i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> to point to
    a program which should generate a list of ports, one per line,
    to standard output.  This listing will then be used in response
	to the level 1 and 2 EnumPorts() RPC.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/listports
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"></a>fake directory create times (S)</span></dt><dd><p>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create 
	time for all files and directories. This is not the same as the 
	ctime - status change time - that Unix keeps, so Samba by default 
	reports the earliest of the various times Unix does keep. Setting 
	this parameter for a share causes Samba to always report midnight 
	1-1-1980 as the create time for directories.</p><p>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for 
	Visual C++ when used against Samba shares. Visual C++ generated 
	makefiles have the object directory as a dependency for each object 
	file, and a make rule to create the directory. Also, when NMAKE 
	compares timestamps it uses the creation time when examining a 
	directory. Thus the object directory will be created if it does not 
	exist, but once it does exist it will always have an earlier 
	timestamp than the object files it contains.</p><p>However, Unix time semantics mean that the create time 
	reported by Samba will be updated whenever a file is created or 
	or deleted in the directory.  NMAKE finds all object files in 
	the object directory.  The timestamp of the last one built is then 
	compared to the timestamp of the object directory.  If the 
	directory's timestamp if newer, then all object files
	will be rebuilt.  Enabling this option 
	ensures directories always predate their contents and an NMAKE build 
	will proceed as expected.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>fake directory create times</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FAKEOPLOCKS"></a>fake oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission 
	from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants 
	an oplock (opportunistic lock) then the client is free to assume 
	that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively 
	cache file data. With some oplock types the client may even cache 
	file open/close operations. This can give enormous performance benefits.
	</p><p>When you set <span><b class="command">fake oplocks = yes</b></span>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will
	always grant oplock requests no matter how many clients are using the file.</p><p>It is generally much better to use the real <a href="#OPLOCKS">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i></a> support rather 
	than this parameter.</p><p>If you enable this option on all read-only shares or 
	shares that you know will only be accessed from one client at a 
	time such as physically read-only media like CDROMs, you will see 
	a big performance improvement on many operations. If you enable 
	this option on shares where multiple clients may be accessing the 
	files read-write at the same time you can get data corruption. Use 
	this option carefully!</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>fake oplocks</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FOLLOWSYMLINKS"></a>follow symlinks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows the Samba administrator 
	to stop <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>	from following symbolic 
	links in a particular share. Setting this 
	parameter to <tt class="constant">no</tt> prevents any file or directory 
	that is a symbolic link from being followed (the user will get an 
	error).  This option is very useful to stop users from adding a 
	symbolic link to <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> in their home 
	directory for instance.  However it will slow filename lookups 
	down slightly.</p><p>This option is enabled (i.e. <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will 
		follow symbolic links) by default.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>follow symlinks</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCECREATEMODE"></a>force create mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit 
    permissions that will <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> be set on a 
    file created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto 
    the mode bits of a file that is being created or having its 
    permissions changed. The default for this parameter is (in octal) 
    000. The modes in this parameter are bitwise 'OR'ed onto the file 
    mode after the mask set in the <i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> 
    parameter is applied.</p><p>The example below would force all created files to have read and execute 
    permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the 
    read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i> = 000
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i> = 0755
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"></a>force directory mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit 
    permissions that will <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> be set on a directory 
    created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto the 
    mode bits of a directory that is being created. The default for this 
    parameter is (in octal) 0000 which will not add any extra permission 
    bits to a created directory. This operation is done after the mode 
    mask in the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i> is 
    applied.</p><p>The example below would force all created directories to have read and execute
    permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the
    read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> = 000
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> = 0755
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"></a>force directory security mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits 
    can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX 
    permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog box.</p><p>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the 
    changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that 
    the user may have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this 
    mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security 
    on a directory, the user has always set to be 'on'.</p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is 000, which 
    allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a 
    directory without restrictions.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Users who can access the 
    Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, 
    so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.  
    Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
	it set as 0000.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i> = 700
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GROUP"></a>group</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for force group.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEGROUP"></a>force group (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be 
    assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting 
    to this service. This is useful for sharing files by ensuring 
    that all access to files on service will use the named group for 
    their permissions checking. Thus, by assigning permissions for this 
    group to the files and directories within this service the Samba 
    administrator can restrict or allow sharing of these files.</p><p>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter has extended 
    functionality in the following way. If the group name listed here 
    has a '+' character prepended to it then the current user accessing 
    the share only has the primary group default assigned to this group 
    if they are already assigned as a member of that group. This allows 
    an administrator to decide that only users who are already in a 
    particular group will create files with group ownership set to that 
    group. This gives a finer granularity of ownership assignment. For 
    example, the setting <tt class="filename">force group = +sys</tt> means 
    that only users who are already in group sys will have their default
    primary group assigned to sys when accessing this Samba share. All
    other users will retain their ordinary primary group.</p><p>If the <a href="#FORCEUSER"><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i>
    </a> parameter is also set the group specified in 
    <i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> will override the primary group
    set in <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> = agroup
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEPRINTERNAME"></a>force printername (S)</span></dt><dd><p>When printing from Windows NT (or later), 
    each printer in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> has two 
    associated names which can be used by the client.  The first
    is the sharename (or shortname) defined in smb.conf.  This
    is the only printername available for use by Windows 9x clients.
    The second name associated with a printer can be seen when 
    browsing to the "Printers" (or "Printers and Faxes") folder 
    on the Samba server.  This is referred to simply as the printername
    (not to be confused with the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i> option).
    </p><p>When assigning a new driver to a printer on a remote 
    Windows compatible print server such as Samba, the Windows client
    will rename the printer to match the driver name just uploaded.
    This can result in confusion for users when multiple 
    printers are bound to the same driver.  To prevent Samba from
    allowing the printer's printername to differ from the sharename
    defined in smb.conf, set <i class="parameter"><tt>force printername = yes</tt></i>.
    </p><p>Be aware that enabling this parameter may affect migrating
    printers from a Windows server to Samba since Windows has no way to 
    force the sharename and printername to match.</p><p>It is recommended that this parameter's value not be changed
    once the printer is in use by clients as this could cause a user
    not be able to delete printer connections from their local Printers 
    folder.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force printername</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCESECURITYMODE"></a>force security mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission 
    bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating 
    the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog 
    box.</p><p>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the 
    changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that 
    the user may have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this 
    mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security 
    on a file, the user has always set to be 'on'.</p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to 0,
    and allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file,
    with no restrictions.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access 
    the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, 
    so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.  
    Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
    this set to 0000.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> = 700
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEUNKNOWNACLUSER"></a>force unknown acl user (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is set, a Windows NT ACL that contains an unknown
              SID (security descriptor, or representation of a user or group
              id) as the owner or group owner of the file will be silently
              mapped into the current UNIX uid or gid of the currently
              connected user.</p><p>This is designed to allow Windows NT clients to copy files and
              folders containing ACLs that were created locally on the client
              machine and contain users local to that machine only (no domain
              users) to be copied to a Samba server (usually with XCOPY /O)
              and have the unknown userid and groupid of the file owner map to
              the current connected user.  This can only be fixed correctly
              when winbindd allows arbitrary mapping from any Windows NT SID
              to a UNIX uid or gid.</p><p>Try using this parameter when XCOPY /O gives an ACCESS_DENIED
    error.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force unknown acl user</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEUSER"></a>force user (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be 
    assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service. 
    This is useful for sharing files. You should also use it carefully 
    as using it incorrectly can cause security problems.</p><p>This user name only gets used once a connection is established. 
    Thus clients still need to connect as a valid user and supply a 
    valid password. Once connected, all file operations will be performed 
    as the "forced user", no matter what username the client connected 
    as.  This can be very useful.</p><p>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter also causes the 
    primary group of the forced user to be used as the primary group 
    for all file activity. Prior to 2.0.5 the primary group was left 
    as the primary group of the connecting user (this was a bug).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> = auser
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FSTYPE"></a>fstype (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows the administrator to 
	configure the string that specifies the type of filesystem a share 
	is using that is reported by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a client queries the filesystem type
	for a share. The default type is <tt class="constant">NTFS</tt> for 
	compatibility with Windows NT but this can be changed to other 
	strings such as <tt class="constant">Samba</tt> or <tt class="constant">FAT
	</tt> if required.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>fstype</tt></i> = NTFS
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>fstype</tt></i> = Samba
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETQUOTACOMMAND"></a>get quota command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <span><b class="command">get quota command</b></span> should only be used 
	whenever there is no operating system API available from the OS that 
	samba can use.</p><p>This option is only available with <span><b class="command">./configure --with-sys-quotas</b></span>.
	Or on linux when <span><b class="command">./configure --with-quotas</b></span> was used and a working quota api 
	was found in the system.</p><p>This parameter should specify the path to a script that 
	queries the quota information for the specified 
	user/group for the partition that 
	the specified directory is on.</p><p>Such a script should take 3 arguments:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>directory</p></li><li><p>type of query</p></li><li><p>uid of user or gid of group</p></li></ul></div><p>The type of query can be one of :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>1 - user quotas</p></li><li><p>2 - user default quotas (uid = -1)</p></li><li><p>3 - group quotas</p></li><li><p>4 - group default quotas (gid = -1)</p></li></ul></div><p>This script should print one line as output with spaces between the arguments. The arguments are: 
	      </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Arg 1 - quota flags (0 = no quotas, 1 = quotas enabled, 2 = quotas enabled and enforced)</p></li><li><p>Arg 2 - number of currently used blocks</p></li><li><p>Arg 3 - the softlimit number of blocks</p></li><li><p>Arg 4 - the hardlimit number of blocks</p></li><li><p>Arg 5 - currently used number of inodes</p></li><li><p>Arg 6 - the softlimit number of inodes</p></li><li><p>Arg 7 - the hardlimit number of inodes</p></li><li><p>Arg 8(optional) - the number of bytes in a block(default is 1024)</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>get quota command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>get quota command</tt></i> = /usr/local/sbin/query_quota
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETWDCACHE"></a>getwd cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a 
    caching algorithm will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd() 
    calls. This can have a significant impact on performance, especially 
    when the <a href="#WIDELINKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i>
</a> parameter is set to <tt class="constant">no</tt>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>getwd cache</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTACCOUNT"></a>guest account (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a username which will be used for access 
    to services which are specified as <a href="#GUESTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    guest ok</tt></i></a> (see below). Whatever privileges this 
    user has will be available to any client connecting to the guest service. 
    This user must exist in the password file, but does not require
    a valid login. The user account "ftp" is often a good choice 
    for this parameter. 
    </p><p>On some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not 
    be able to print. Use another account in this case. You should test 
    this by trying to log in as your guest user (perhaps by using the 
    <span><b class="command">su -</b></span> command) and trying to print using the 
    system print command such as <span><b class="command">lpr(1)</b></span> or <span><b class="command">
    lp(1)</b></span>.</p><p>This parameter does not accept % macros, because
    many parts of the system require this value to be
	constant for correct operation.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> = nobody
# default can be changed at compile-time
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> = ftp
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PUBLIC"></a>public</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for guest ok.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTOK"></a>guest ok (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt> for 
    a service, then no password is required to connect to the service. 
    Privileges will be those of the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    guest account</tt></i></a>.</p><p>This paramater nullifies the benifits of setting
    <a href="#RESTRICTANONYMOUS"><i class="parameter"><tt>restrict
    anonymous</tt></i></a> = 2</p><p>See the section below on <a href="#SECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    security</tt></i></a> for more information about this option.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ONLYGUEST"></a>only guest</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for guest only.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTONLY"></a>guest only (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt> for 
    a service, then only guest connections to the service are permitted. 
    This parameter will have no effect if <a href="#GUESTOK">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></a> is not set for the service.</p><p>See the section below on <a href="#SECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    security</tt></i></a> for more information about this option.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>guest only</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEDOTFILES"></a>hide dot files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether 
	files starting with a dot appear as hidden files.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hide dot files</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEFILES"></a>hide files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of files or directories that are not 
	visible but are accessible.  The DOS 'hidden' attribute is applied 
	to any files or directories that match.</p><p>Each entry in the list must be separated by a '/', 
	which allows spaces to be included in the entry.  '*'
	and '?' can be used to specify multiple files or directories 
	as in DOS wildcards.</p><p>Each entry must be a Unix path, not a DOS path and must 
	not include the Unix directory separator '/'.</p><p>Note that the case sensitivity option is applicable 
	in hiding files.</p><p>Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba, 
	as it will be forced to check all files and directories for a match 
	as they are scanned.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i> = 
# no file are hidden
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i> = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
# 
The above example is based on files that the Macintosh 
SMB client (DAVE) available from <a href="http://www.thursby.com" target="_top"> 
Thursby</a> creates for internal use, and also still hides 
all files beginning with a dot.
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDESPECIALFILES"></a>hide special files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter prevents clients from seeing
	special files such as sockets, devices and fifo's in directory 
	listings.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hide special files</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEUNREADABLE"></a>hide unreadable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter prevents clients from seeing the
		existance of files that cannot be read. Defaults to off.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unreadable</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"></a>hide unwriteable files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter prevents clients from seeing
	the existance of files that cannot be written to. Defaults to off.
	Note that unwriteable directories are shown as usual.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unwriteable files</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOMEDIRMAP"></a>homedir map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If<a href="#NISHOMEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>nis homedir
	</tt></i></a> is <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> is also acting 
	as a Win95/98 <i class="parameter"><tt>logon server</tt></i> then this parameter 
	specifies the NIS (or YP) map from which the server for the user's 
	home directory should be extracted.  At present, only the Sun 
	auto.home map format is understood. The form of the map is:</p><p><span><b class="command">username	server:/some/file/system</b></span></p><p>and the program will extract the servername from before 
	the first ':'.  There should probably be a better parsing system 
	that copes with different map formats and also Amd (another 
	automounter) maps.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>A working NIS client is required on 
	the system for this option to work.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>homedir map</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>homedir map</tt></i> = amd.homedir
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTMSDFS"></a>host msdfs (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, Samba will act as a Dfs
	server, and allow Dfs-aware clients to browse Dfs trees hosted
	on the server.</p><p>See also the <a href="#MSDFSROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	msdfs root</tt></i></a> share  level  parameter.  For
	more  information  on  setting  up a Dfs tree on Samba,
	refer to <a href="#">???</a>.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"></a>hostname lookups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether samba should use (expensive)
    hostname lookups or use the ip addresses instead. An example place
    where hostname lookups are currently used is when checking 
    the <span><b class="command">hosts deny</b></span> and <span><b class="command">hosts allow</b></span>.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hostname lookups</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hostname lookups</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALLOWHOSTS"></a>allow hosts</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for hosts allow.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTSALLOW"></a>hosts allow (S)</span></dt><dd><p>A synonym for this parameter is <i class="parameter"><tt>allow 
    hosts</tt></i>.</p><p>This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited 
    set of hosts which are permitted to access a service.</p><p>If specified in the [global] section then it will
    apply to all services, regardless of whether the individual 
    service has a different setting.</p><p>You can specify the hosts by name or IP number. For 
    example, you could restrict access to only the hosts on a 
    Class C subnet with something like <span><b class="command">allow hosts = 150.203.5.
    </b></span>. The full syntax of the list is described in the man 
    page <tt class="filename">hosts_access(5)</tt>. Note that this man
    page may not be present on your system, so a brief description will
    be given here also.</p><p>Note that the localhost address 127.0.0.1 will always 
    be allowed access unless specifically denied by a <a href="#HOSTSDENY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i></a> option.</p><p>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and 
    by netgroup names if your system supports netgroups. The 
    <span class="emphasis"><em>EXCEPT</em></span> keyword can also be used to limit a 
    wildcard list. The following examples may provide some help:</p><p>Example 1: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.*; except one</p><p><span><b class="command">hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</b></span></p><p>Example 2: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask</p><p><span><b class="command">hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</b></span></p><p>Example 3: allow a couple of hosts</p><p><span><b class="command">hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</b></span></p><p>Example 4: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but 
    deny access from one particular host</p><p><span><b class="command">hosts allow = @foonet</b></span></p><p><span><b class="command">hosts deny = pirate</b></span></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</p></div><p>See <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> for a way of testing your host access 
    to see if it does what you expect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> = 
# none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> = 150.203.5. myhost.mynet.edu.au
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DENYHOSTS"></a>deny hosts</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for hosts deny.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTSDENY"></a>hosts deny (S)</span></dt><dd><p>The opposite of <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> 
    - hosts listed here are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> permitted access to 
    services unless the specific services have their own lists to override 
    this one. Where the lists conflict, the <i class="parameter"><tt>allow</tt></i> 
	list takes precedence.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> = 
# none (i.e., no hosts specifically excluded)
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> = 150.203.4. badhost.mynet.edu.au
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTSEQUIV"></a>hosts equiv (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If this global parameter is a non-null string, 
    it specifies the name of a file to read for the names of hosts 
    and users who will be allowed access without specifying a password.
    </p><p>This is not be confused with <a href="#HOSTSALLOW">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i></a> which is about hosts 
    access to services and is more useful for guest services. <i class="parameter"><tt>
    hosts equiv</tt></i> may be useful for NT clients which will 
    not supply passwords to Samba.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>The use of <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv
    </tt></i> can be a major security hole. This is because you are 
    trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is very easy to 
    get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the 
    <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv</tt></i> option be only used if you really 
    know what you are doing, or perhaps on a home network where you trust 
    your spouse and kids. And only if you <span class="emphasis"><em>really</em></span> trust 
	them :-).</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv</tt></i> = 
# no host equivalences
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv</tt></i> = hosts equiv = /etc/hosts.equiv
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPBACKEND"></a>idmap backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
	The purpose of the idmap backend parameter is to allow idmap to NOT use the local idmap
	tdb file to obtain SID to UID / GID mappings, but instead to obtain them from a common
	LDAP backend. This way all domain members and controllers will have the same UID and GID
	to SID mappings. This avoids the risk of UID / GID inconsistencies across UNIX / Linux
	systems that are sharing information over protocols other than SMB/CIFS (ie: NFS).
	</p><p>
	An alternate method of SID to UID / GID  mapping can be achieved using the idmap_rid
	plug-in. This plug-in uses the account RID to derive the UID and GID by adding the
	RID to a base value specified. This utility requires that the parameter
	&#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>allow trusted domains = No</em></span></span>&#8221; must be specified, as it is not compatible
	with multiple domain environments. The idmap uid and idmap gid ranges must also be
	specified.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> = ldap:ldap://ldapslave.example.com
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> = idmap_rid:DOMNAME=1000-100000000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDGID"></a>winbind gid</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for idmap gid.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPGID"></a>idmap gid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The idmap gid parameter specifies the range of group ids that are allocated for
	the purpose of mapping UNX groups to NT group SIDs. This range of group ids should have no 
	existing local or NIS groups within it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>The availability of an idmap gid range is essential for correct operation of
		all group mapping.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> = 10000-20000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUID"></a>winbind uid</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for idmap uid.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPUID"></a>idmap uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The idmap uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are allocated for use
	in mapping UNIX users to NT user SIDs. This range of ids should have no existing local
	or NIS users within it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i> = 10000-20000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INCLUDE"></a>include (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This allows you to include one config file 
	inside another.  The file is included literally, as though typed 
	in place.</p><p>It takes the standard substitutions, except <i class="parameter"><tt>%u
	</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>%P</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>%S</tt></i>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>include</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>include</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/lib/admin_smb.conf
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INHERITACLS"></a>inherit acls (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter can be used to ensure that if default acls
    exist on parent directories, they are always honored when creating a
    subdirectory. The default behavior is to use the mode specified when
    creating the directory.  Enabling this option sets the mode to 0777,
    thus guaranteeing that  default directory acls are propagated.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>inherit acls</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INHERITPERMISSIONS"></a>inherit permissions (S)</span></dt><dd><p>The permissions on new files and directories 
    are normally governed by <a href="#CREATEMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    create mask</tt></i></a>, <a href="#DIRECTORYMASK">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i></a>, <a href="#FORCECREATEMODE">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i>
    </a> and <a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force 
    directory mode</tt></i></a> but the boolean inherit 
    permissions parameter overrides this.</p><p>New directories inherit the mode of the parent directory,
    including bits such as setgid.</p><p>New files inherit their read/write bits from the parent 
    directory.  Their execute bits continue to be determined by
    <a href="#MAPARCHIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>map archive</tt></i>
    </a>, <a href="#MAPHIDDEN"><i class="parameter"><tt>map hidden</tt></i>
    </a> and <a href="#MAPSYSTEM"><i class="parameter"><tt>map system</tt></i>
    </a> as usual.</p><p>Note that the setuid bit is <span class="emphasis"><em>never</em></span> set via 
    inheritance (the code explicitly prohibits this).</p><p>This can be particularly useful on large systems with 
    many users, perhaps several thousand, to allow a single [homes] 
    share to be used flexibly by each user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>inherit permissions</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INTERFACES"></a>interfaces (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the default 
	network interfaces list that Samba will use for browsing, name 
	registration and other NBT traffic. By default Samba will query 
	the kernel for the list of all active interfaces and use any 
	interfaces except 127.0.0.1 that are broadcast capable.</p><p>The option takes a list of interface strings. Each string 
	can be in any of the following forms:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a network interface name (such as eth0). 
		This may include shell-like wildcards so eth* will match 
		any interface starting with the substring "eth"</p></li><li><p>an IP address. In this case the netmask is 
		determined from the list of interfaces obtained from the 
		kernel</p></li><li><p>an IP/mask pair. </p></li><li><p>a broadcast/mask pair.</p></li></ul></div><p>The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such 
	as 24 for a C class network) or a full netmask in dotted 
	decimal form.</p><p>The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted 
	decimal IP address or a hostname which will be looked up via 
	the OS's normal hostname resolution mechanisms.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> = 
# all active interfaces except 127.0.0.1 that are broadcast capable
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> = 
	
# This would configure three network interfaces corresponding 
	to the eth0 device and IP addresses 192.168.2.10 and 192.168.3.10. 
	The netmasks of the latter two interfaces would be set to 255.255.255.0.
	eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0

</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INVALIDUSERS"></a>invalid users (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that should not be allowed 
    to login to this service. This is really a <span class="emphasis"><em>paranoid</em></span> 
    check to absolutely ensure an improper setting does not breach 
    your security.</p><p>A name starting with a '@' is interpreted as an NIS 
    netgroup first (if your system supports NIS), and then as a UNIX 
    group if the name was not found in the NIS netgroup database.</p><p>A name starting with '+' is interpreted only 
    by looking in the UNIX group database. A name starting with 
    '&amp;' is interpreted only by looking in the NIS netgroup database 
    (this requires NIS to be working on your system). The characters 
    '+' and '&amp;' may be used at the start of the name in either order 
    so the value <i class="parameter"><tt>+&amp;group</tt></i> means check the 
    UNIX group database, followed by the NIS netgroup database, and 
    the value <i class="parameter"><tt>&amp;+group</tt></i> means check the NIS
    netgroup database, followed by the UNIX group database (the 
    same as the '@' prefix).</p><p>The current servicename is substituted for <i class="parameter"><tt>%S</tt></i>. 
		This is useful in the [homes] section.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> = 
# no invalid users
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> = root fred admin @wheel
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KEEPALIVE"></a>keepalive (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents 
    the number of seconds between <i class="parameter"><tt>keepalive</tt></i> 
    packets. If this parameter is zero, no keepalive packets will be 
    sent. Keepalive packets, if sent, allow the server to tell whether 
    a client is still present and responding.</p><p>Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket 
    being used has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it (see <a href="#SOCKETOPTIONS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i></a>). 
Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>keepalive</tt></i> = 300
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>keepalive</tt></i> = 600
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELCHANGENOTIFY"></a>kernel change notify (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should ask the 
	kernel for change notifications in directories so that
	SMB clients can refresh whenever the data on the server changes.
	</p><p>This parameter is only used when your kernel supports 
	change notification to user programs, using the F_NOTIFY fcntl.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel change notify</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELOPLOCKS"></a>kernel oplocks (G)</span></dt><dd><p>For UNIXes that support kernel based <a href="#OPLOCKS">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i></a>
	(currently only IRIX and the Linux 2.4 kernel), this parameter 
	allows the use of them to be turned on or off.</p><p>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks
	</tt></i> to be broken whenever a local UNIX process or NFS operation 
	accesses a file that <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has oplocked. This allows complete 
	data consistency between SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is 
	a <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> cool feature :-).</p><p>This parameter defaults to <tt class="constant">on</tt>, but is translated
	to a no-op on systems that no not have the necessary kernel support.
	You should never need to touch this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LANMANAUTH"></a>lanman auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to authenticate users 
    using the LANMAN password hash. If disabled, only clients which support NT 
    password hashes (e.g. Windows NT/2000 clients, smbclient, etc... but not 
    Windows 95/98 or the MS DOS network client) will be able to connect to the Samba host.</p><p>The LANMAN encrypted response is easily broken, due to it's
    case-insensitive nature, and the choice of algorithm.  Servers
    without Windows 95/98 or MS DOS clients are advised to disable
    this option.  </p><p>Unlike the <span><b class="command">encypt
    passwords</b></span> option, this parameter cannot alter client
    behaviour, and the LANMAN response will still be sent over the
    network.  See the <span><b class="command">client lanman
    auth</b></span> to disable this for Samba's clients (such as smbclient)</p><p>If this option, and <span><b class="command">ntlm
    auth</b></span> are both disabled, then only NTLMv2 logins will be
    permited.  Not all clients support NTLMv2, and most will require
    special configuration to us it.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lanman auth</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LARGEREADWRITE"></a>large readwrite (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> supports the new 64k
    streaming read and write varient SMB requests introduced with
    Windows 2000. Note that due to Windows 2000 client redirector bugs
    this requires Samba to be running on a 64-bit capable operating
    system such as IRIX, Solaris or a Linux 2.4 kernel. Can improve
    performance by 10% with Windows 2000 clients. Defaults to on. Not as
	tested as some other Samba code paths.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>large readwrite</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPADMINDN"></a>ldap admin dn (G)</span></dt><dd><p> The <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i>
	defines the Distinguished  Name (DN) name used by Samba to
	contact the ldap server when retreiving  user account
	information. The <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin
	dn</tt></i> is used in conjunction with the admin dn password
	stored in the <tt class="filename">private/secrets.tdb</tt> file.
	See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> man page for more
	information on how  to accmplish this.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPDELETEDN"></a>ldap delete dn (G)</span></dt><dd><p> This parameter specifies whether a delete
	operation in the ldapsam deletes the complete entry or only the attributes
	specific to Samba.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPFILTER"></a>ldap filter (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the RFC 2254 compliant LDAP search filter.
	The default is to match the login name with the <tt class="constant">uid</tt> 
	attribute. Note that this filter should only return one entry.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i> = (uid=%u)
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i> = (&amp;(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaSamAccount))
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPGROUPSUFFIX"></a>ldap group suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters specifies the suffix that is 
	used for groups when these are added to the LDAP directory.
	If this parameter is unset, the value of <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> will be used instead.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap group suffix</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap group suffix</tt></i> = dc=samba,ou=Groups
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPIDMAPSUFFIX"></a>ldap idmap suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters specifies the suffix that is 
	used when storing idmap mappings. If this parameter 
	is unset, the value of <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i>
	will be used instead.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i> = ou=Idmap,dc=samba,dc=org
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"></a>ldap machine suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>It specifies where machines should be added to the ldap tree.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"></a>ldap passwd sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to define whether
	or not Samba should sync the LDAP password with the NT
	and LM hashes for normal accounts (NOT for
	workstation, server or domain trusts) on a password
	change via SAMBA.  
	</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd
	sync</tt></i> can be set to one of three values: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>Yes</tt></i>  =  Try 
			to update the LDAP, NT and LM passwords and update the pwdLastSet time.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>No</tt></i> = Update NT and 
			LM passwords and update the pwdLastSet time.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>Only</tt></i> = Only update 
			the LDAP password and let the LDAP server do the rest.</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPPORT"></a>ldap port (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
	configure to include the <span><b class="command">--with-ldapsam</b></span> option
	at compile time.</p><p>This option is used to control the tcp port number used to contact
	the <a href="#LDAPSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap server</tt></i></a>.
	The default is to use the stand LDAPS port 636.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap port</tt></i> = 636
# if ldap ssl = on
</em></span>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap port</tt></i> = 389
# if ldap ssl = off
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPREPLICATIONSLEEP"></a>ldap replication sleep (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When Samba is asked to write to a read-only LDAP
replica, we are redirected to talk to the read-write master server.
This server then replicates our changes back to the 'local' server,
however the replication might take some seconds, especially over slow
links.  Certain client activities, particularly domain joins, can become
confused by the 'success' that does not immediately change the LDAP
back-end's data.  </p><p>This option simply causes Samba to wait a short time, to
allow the LDAP server to catch up.  If you have a particularly
high-latency network, you may wish to time the LDAP replication with a
network sniffer, and increase this value accordingly.  Be aware that no
checking is performed that the data has actually replicated.</p><p>The value is specified in milliseconds, the maximum
value is 5000 (5 seconds).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap replication sleep</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSERVER"></a>ldap server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
	configure to include the <span><b class="command">--with-ldapsam</b></span> 
	option at compile time.</p><p>This parameter should contain the FQDN of the ldap directory
	server which should be queried to locate user account information.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap server</tt></i> = localhost
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSSL"></a>ldap ssl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to define whether or not Samba should
	use SSL when connecting to the ldap server
	This is <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> related to
	Samba's previous SSL support which was enabled by specifying the 
	<span><b class="command">--with-ssl</b></span> option to the <tt class="filename">configure</tt> 
	script.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> can be set to one of three values:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>Off</tt></i> = Never 
			use SSL when querying the directory.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>Start_tls</tt></i> = Use 
			the LDAPv3 StartTLS extended operation (RFC2830) for 
			communicating with the directory server.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>On</tt></i>  = Use SSL 
			on the ldaps port when contacting the <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap server</tt></i>. Only available when the 
			backwards-compatiblity <span><b class="command">--with-ldapsam</b></span> option is specified
			to configure. See <a href="#PASSDBBACKEND"><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = start_tls
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSUFFIX"></a>ldap suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies where user and machine accounts are added to the
	tree. Can be overriden by <span><b class="command">ldap user
	suffix</b></span> and <span><b class="command">ldap machine
	suffix</b></span>. It also used as the base dn for all ldap
searches. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPTIMEOUT"></a>ldap timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When Samba connects to an ldap server that server
may be down or unreachable. To prevent Samba from hanging whilst
waiting for the connection this parameter specifies in seconds how
long Samba should wait before failing the connect. The default is
to only wait fifteen seconds for the ldap server to respond to the
connect request.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap timeout</tt></i> = 15
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"></a>ldap user suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies where users are added to the tree. 
	If this parameter is not specified, the value from <span><b class="command">ldap suffix</b></span>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"></a>level2 oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether Samba supports
	level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share.</p><p>Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients 
	that have an oplock on a file to downgrade from a read-write oplock 
	to a read-only oplock once a second client opens the file (instead 
	of releasing all oplocks on a second open, as in traditional, 
	exclusive oplocks). This allows all openers of the file that 
	support level2 oplocks to cache the file for read-ahead only (ie. 
	they may not cache writes or lock requests) and increases performance 
	for many accesses of files that are not commonly written (such as 
	application .EXE files).</p><p>Once one of the clients which have a read-only oplock 
	writes to the file all clients are notified (no reply is needed 
	or waited for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and 
	delete any read-ahead caches.</p><p>It is recommended that this parameter be turned on to
	speed access to shared executables.</p><p>For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.</p><p>Currently, if <a href="#KERNELOPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel 
	oplocks</tt></i></a> are supported then level2 oplocks are 
	not granted (even if this parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>). 
	Note also, the <a href="#OPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i>
	</a> parameter must be set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> on this share in order for 
	this parameter to have any effect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>level2 oplocks</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LMANNOUNCE"></a>lm announce (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will produce Lanman announce 
	broadcasts that are needed by OS/2 clients in order for them to see 
	the Samba server in their browse list. This parameter can have three 
	values, <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, <tt class="constant">no</tt>, or
	<tt class="constant">auto</tt>. The default is <tt class="constant">auto</tt>.  
	If set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> Samba will never produce these 
	broadcasts. If set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> Samba will produce 
	Lanman announce broadcasts at a frequency set by the parameter 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i>. If set to <tt class="constant">auto</tt> 
	Samba will not send Lanman announce broadcasts by default but will 
	listen for them. If it hears such a broadcast on the wire it will 
	then start sending them at a frequency set by the parameter 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i> = auto
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LMINTERVAL"></a>lm interval (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce 
	broadcasts needed by OS/2 clients (see the <a href="#LMANNOUNCE">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i></a> parameter) then this 
	parameter defines the frequency in seconds with which they will be 
	made.  If this is set to zero then no Lanman announcements will be 
	made despite the setting of the <i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i> 
	parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i> = 60
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i> = 120
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOADPRINTERS"></a>load printers (G)</span></dt><dd><p>A boolean variable that controls whether all 
    printers in the printcap will be loaded for browsing by default. 
    See the <a href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">printers</a> section for 
	more details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCALMASTER"></a>local master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to try and become a local master browser 
	on a subnet. If set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> then <span><b class="command">
	nmbd</b></span> will not attempt to become a local master browser 
	on a subnet and will also lose in all browsing elections. By
	default this value is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. Setting this value to 
	<tt class="constant">yes</tt> doesn't mean that Samba will <span class="emphasis"><em>become</em></span> the 
	local master browser on a subnet, just that <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> 
	will <span class="emphasis"><em>participate</em></span> in elections for local master browser.</p><p>Setting this value to <tt class="constant">no</tt> will cause <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> <span class="emphasis"><em>never</em></span> to become a local 
master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKDIR"></a>lock dir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for lock directory.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKDIRECTORY"></a>lock directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the directory where lock 
	files will be placed.  The lock files are used to implement the 
	<a href="#MAXCONNECTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i>
</a> option.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lock directory</tt></i> = ${prefix}/var/locks
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lock directory</tt></i> = /var/run/samba/locks
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKING"></a>locking (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether or not locking will be 
	performed by the server in response to lock requests from the 
	client.</p><p>If <span><b class="command">locking = no</b></span>, all lock and unlock 
	requests will appear to succeed and all lock queries will report 
	that the file in question is available for locking.</p><p>If <span><b class="command">locking = yes</b></span>, real locking will be performed 
	by the server.</p><p>This option <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> be useful for read-only 
	filesystems which <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> not need locking (such as 
	CDROM drives), although setting this parameter of <tt class="constant">no</tt> 
	is not really recommended even in this case.</p><p>Be careful about disabling locking either globally or in a 
	specific service, as lack of locking may result in data corruption. 
	You should never need to set this parameter.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKSPINCOUNT"></a>lock spin count (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the number of times
	that smbd should attempt to gain a byte range lock on the 
	behalf of a client request.  Experiments have shown that
	Windows 2k servers do not reply with a failure if the lock
	could not be immediately granted, but try a few more times
	in case the lock could later be acquired.  This behavior
	is used to support PC database formats such as MS Access
	and FoxPro.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin count</tt></i> = 3
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKSPINTIME"></a>lock spin time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The time in microseconds that smbd should 
	pause before attempting to gain a failed lock.  See
	<a href="#LOCKSPINCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin 
			count</tt></i></a> for more details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin time</tt></i> = 10
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGFILE"></a>log file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the name 
    of the Samba log file (also known as the debug file).</p><p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing 
		you to have separate log files for each user or machine.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>log file</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/var/log.%m
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGLEVEL"></a>debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for log level.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGLEVEL"></a>log level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a astring) allows 
    the debug level (logging level) to be specified in the 
    <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. This parameter has been
    extended since the 2.2.x series, now it allow to specify the debug
    level for multiple debug classes. This is to give greater 
    flexibility in the configuration of the system.</p><p>The default will be the log level specified on 
    the command line or level zero if none was specified.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> = 3 passdb:5 auth:10 winbind:2
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONDRIVE"></a>logon drive (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the local path to 
	which the home directory will be connected (see <a href="#LOGONHOME">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></a>) 
	and is only used by NT Workstations. </p><p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
		logon server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i> = z:
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i> = h:
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONHOME"></a>logon home (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the home directory 
	location when a Win95/98 or NT Workstation logs into a Samba PDC.  
	It allows you to do </p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\&gt;</tt>
	<b class="userinput"><tt>NET USE H: /HOME</tt></b>
	</p><p>from a command prompt, for example.</p><p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing 
	you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</p><p>This parameter can be used with Win9X workstations to ensure 
	that roaming profiles are stored in a subdirectory of the user's 
	home directory.  This is done in the following way:</p><p><span><b class="command">logon home = \\%N\%U\profile</b></span></p><p>This tells Samba to return the above string, with 
	substitutions made when a client requests the info, generally 
	in a NetUserGetInfo request.  Win9X clients truncate the info to
	\\server\share when a user does <span><b class="command">net use /home</b></span>
	but use the whole string when dealing with profiles.</p><p>Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <a href="#LOGONPATH">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i></a> was returned rather than 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>.  This broke <span><b class="command">net use /home</b></span> but allowed profiles outside the home directory.  
	The current implementation is correct, and can be used for profiles if you use 
	the above trick.</p><p>This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon 
	server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> = \\%N\%U
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> = \\remote_smb_server\%U
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONPATH"></a>logon path (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the home directory 
	where roaming profiles (NTuser.dat etc files for Windows NT) are 
	stored.  Contrary to previous versions of these manual pages, it has 
	nothing to do with Win 9X roaming profiles.  To find out how to 
	handle roaming profiles for Win 9X system, see the <a href="#LOGONHOME">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you 
	to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.  It also 
	specifies the directory from which the "Application Data", 
	(<tt class="filename">desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">start menu</tt>,
	<tt class="filename">network neighborhood</tt>, <tt class="filename">programs</tt> 
	and other folders, and their contents, are loaded and displayed on 
	your Windows NT client.</p><p>The share and the path must be readable by the user for 
	the preferences and directories to be loaded onto the Windows NT
	client. The share must be writeable when the user logs in for the first
	time, in order that the Windows NT client can create the NTuser.dat
	and other directories.</p><p>Thereafter, the directories and any of the contents can, 
	if required, be made read-only.  It is not advisable that the 
	NTuser.dat file be made read-only - rename it to NTuser.man to 
	achieve the desired effect (a <span class="emphasis"><em>MAN</em></span>datory 
	profile). </p><p>Windows clients can sometimes maintain a connection to 
	the [homes] share, even though there is no user logged in.  
	Therefore, it is vital that the logon path does not include a 
	reference to the homes share (i.e. setting this parameter to
	\%N\%U\profile_path will cause problems).</p><p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing 
	you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>
        Do not quote the value. Setting this as &#8220;<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>\\%N\profile\%U</em></span></span>&#8221;
		will break profile handling.  </p></div><p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up 
	as a logon server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> = \\%N\%U\profile
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> = &gt;\\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONSCRIPT"></a>logon script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the batch file (.bat) or 
	NT command file (.cmd) to be downloaded and run on a machine when 
	a user successfully logs in.  The file must contain the DOS 
	style CR/LF line endings. Using a DOS-style editor to create the 
	file is recommended.</p><p>The script must be a relative path to the [netlogon] 
	service.  If the [netlogon] service specifies a <a href="#PATH">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i></a> of <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/netlogon</tt>, and <span><b class="command">logon script = STARTUP.BAT</b></span>, then 
	the file that will be downloaded is:</p><p><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/netlogon/STARTUP.BAT</tt></p><p>The contents of the batch file are entirely your choice.  A 
	suggested command would be to add <span><b class="command">NET TIME \\SERVER /SET 
	/YES</b></span>, to force every machine to synchronize clocks with 
	the same time server.  Another use would be to add <span><b class="command">NET USE 
	U: \\SERVER\UTILS</b></span> for commonly used utilities, or </p><pre class="screen">
	<b class="userinput"><tt>NET USE Q: \\SERVER\ISO9001_QA</tt></b></pre><p> for example.</p><p>Note that it is particularly important not to allow write 
	access to the [netlogon] share, or to grant users write permission 
	on the batch files in a secure environment, as this would allow 
	the batch files to be arbitrarily modified and security to be 
	breached.</p><p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you 
	to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</p><p>This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon 
		server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i> = scripts\%U.bat
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPPAUSECOMMAND"></a>lppause command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be 
    executed on the server host in order to stop printing or spooling 
    a specific print job.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes 
    a printer name and job number to pause the print job. One way 
    of implementing this is by using job priorities, where jobs 
    having a too low priority won't be sent to the printer.</p><p>If a <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is given then the printer name 
    is put in its place. A <i class="parameter"><tt>%j</tt></i> is replaced with 
    the job number (an integer).  On HPUX (see <i class="parameter"><tt>printing=hpux
    </tt></i>), if the <i class="parameter"><tt>-p%p</tt></i> option is added 
    to the lpq command, the job will show up with the correct status, i.e. 
    if the job priority is lower than the set fence priority it will 
    have the PAUSED status, whereas if  the priority is equal or higher it 
    will have the SPOOLED or PRINTING status.</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path 
    in the lppause command as the PATH may not be available to the server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i> = 
# Currently no default value is given to 
    this string, unless the value of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> 
	parameter is <tt class="constant">SYSV</tt>, in which case the default is : <span><b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></span> or if the value of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is <tt class="constant">SOFTQ</tt>, then the default is: <span><b class="command">qstat -s -j%j -h</b></span>. 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p0
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPQCACHETIME"></a>lpq cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls how long lpq info will be cached 
	for to prevent the <span><b class="command">lpq</b></span> command being called too 
	often. A separate cache is kept for each variation of the <span><b class="command">
	lpq</b></span> command used by the system, so if you use different 
	<span><b class="command">lpq</b></span> commands for different users then they won't
	share cache information.</p><p>The cache files are stored in <tt class="filename">/tmp/lpq.xxxx</tt> 
	where xxxx is a hash of the <span><b class="command">lpq</b></span> command in use.</p><p>The default is 10 seconds, meaning that the cached results 
	of a previous identical <span><b class="command">lpq</b></span> command will be used 
	if the cached data is less than 10 seconds old. A large value may 
	be advisable if your <span><b class="command">lpq</b></span> command is very slow.</p><p>A value of 0 will disable caching completely.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i> = 10
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i> = 30
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPQCOMMAND"></a>lpq command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be 
    executed on the server host in order to obtain <span><b class="command">lpq
    </b></span>-style printer status information.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which 
    takes a printer name as its only parameter and outputs printer 
    status information.</p><p>Currently nine styles of printer status information 
    are supported; BSD, AIX, LPRNG, PLP, SYSV, HPUX, QNX, CUPS, and SOFTQ. 
    This covers most UNIX systems. You control which type is expected 
    using the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing =</tt></i> option.</p><p>Some clients (notably Windows for Workgroups) may not 
    correctly send the connection number for the printer they are 
    requesting status information about. To get around this, the 
    server reports on the first printer service connected to by the 
    client. This only happens if the connection number sent is invalid.</p><p>If a <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is given then the printer name 
    is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the 
    command.</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path 
    in the <i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i> as the <tt class="envar">$PATH
    </tt> may not be available to the server.  When compiled with
    the CUPS libraries, no <i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i> is
    needed because smbd will make a library call to obtain the 
	print queue listing.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/lpq -P%p
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPRESUMECOMMAND"></a>lpresume command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be 
    executed on the server host in order to restart or continue 
    printing or spooling a specific print job.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes 
    a printer name and job number to resume the print job. See 
    also the <a href="#LPPAUSECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command
    </tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>If a <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is given then the printer name 
    is put in its place. A <i class="parameter"><tt>%j</tt></i> is replaced with 
    the job number (an integer).</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path 
    in the <i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i> as the PATH may not 
    be available to the server.</p><p>See also the <a href="#PRINTING"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing
    </tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: Currently no default value is given 
    to this string, unless the value of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> 
    parameter is <tt class="constant">SYSV</tt>, in which case the default is :</p><p><span><b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></span></p><p>or if the value of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter 
		is <tt class="constant">SOFTQ</tt>, then the default is:</p><p><span><b class="command">qstat -s -j%j -r</b></span></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i> = lpresume command = /usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p2
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPRMCOMMAND"></a>lprm command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be 
    executed on the server host in order to delete a print job.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes 
    a printer name and job number, and deletes the print job.</p><p>If a <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is given then the printer name 
    is put in its place. A <i class="parameter"><tt>%j</tt></i> is replaced with 
    the job number (an integer).</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute 
    path in the <i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i> as the PATH may not be 
    available to the server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i> = 
# depends on the setting of <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i> = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"></a>machine password timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If a Samba server is a member of a Windows 
	NT Domain (see the <a href="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">security = domain</a>
	parameter) then periodically a running smbd
	 process will try and change the MACHINE ACCOUNT 
	PASSWORD stored in the TDB called <tt class="filename">private/secrets.tdb
	</tt>.  This parameter specifies how often this password 
	will be changed, in seconds. The default is one week (expressed in 
	seconds), the same as a Windows NT Domain member server.</p><p>See also <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, and the <a href="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">
	security = domain</a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>machine password timeout</tt></i> = 604800
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAGICOUTPUT"></a>magic output (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a file 
	which will contain output created by a magic script (see the 
	<a href="#MAGICSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>magic script</tt></i></a>
	parameter below).</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>If two clients use the same <i class="parameter"><tt>magic script
	</tt></i> in the same directory the output file content
	is undefined.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>magic output</tt></i> = &lt;magic script name&gt;.out
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>magic output</tt></i> = myfile.txt
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAGICSCRIPT"></a>magic script (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a file which, 
	if opened, will be executed by the server when the file is closed. 
	This allows a UNIX script to be sent to the Samba host and 
	executed on behalf of the connected user.</p><p>Scripts executed in this way will be deleted upon 
	completion assuming that the user has the appropriate level 
	of privilege and the file permissions allow the deletion.</p><p>If the script generates output, output will be sent to 
	the file specified by the <a href="#MAGICOUTPUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	magic output</tt></i></a> parameter (see above).</p><p>Note that some shells are unable to interpret scripts 
	containing CR/LF instead of CR as 
	the end-of-line marker. Magic scripts must be executable 
	<span class="emphasis"><em>as is</em></span> on the host, which for some hosts and 
	some shells will require filtering at the DOS end.</p><p>Magic scripts are <span class="emphasis"><em>EXPERIMENTAL</em></span> and 
		should <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be relied upon.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>magic script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>magic script</tt></i> = user.csh
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEDMAP"></a>mangled map (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is for those who want to directly map UNIX 
	file names which cannot be represented on Windows/DOS.  The mangling 
	of names is not always what is needed.  In particular you may have 
	documents with file extensions that differ between DOS and UNIX. 
	For example, under UNIX it is common to use <tt class="filename">.html</tt> 
	for HTML files, whereas under Windows/DOS <tt class="filename">.htm</tt> 
	is more commonly used.</p><p>So to map <tt class="filename">html</tt> to <tt class="filename">htm</tt> 
	you would use:</p><p><span><b class="command">mangled map = (*.html *.htm)</b></span></p><p>One very useful case is to remove the annoying <tt class="filename">;1
	</tt> off the ends of filenames on some CDROMs (only visible 
	under some UNIXes). To do this use a map of (*;1 *;).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled map</tt></i> = 
# no mangled map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled map</tt></i> = (*;1 *;)
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEDNAMES"></a>mangled names (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX 
	should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible, 
	or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a> for 
	details on how to control the mangling process.</p><p>If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters 
			before the rightmost dot of the filename are preserved, forced 
			to upper case, and appear as the first (up to) five characters 
			of the mangled name.</p></li><li><p>A tilde "~" is appended to the first part of the mangled
			name, followed by a two-character unique sequence, based on the
			original root name (i.e., the original filename minus its final
			extension). The final extension is included in the hash calculation
			only if it contains any upper case characters or is longer than three
			characters.</p><p>Note that the character to use may be specified using 
			the <a href="#MANGLINGCHAR"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling char</tt></i>
			</a> option, if you don't like '~'.</p></li><li><p>The first three alphanumeric characters of the final 
			extension are preserved, forced to upper case and appear as the 
			extension of the mangled name. The final extension is defined as that 
			part of the original filename after the rightmost dot. If there are no 
			dots in the filename, the mangled name will have no extension (except 
			in the case of "hidden files" - see below).</p></li><li><p>Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be 
			presented as DOS hidden files. The mangled name will be created as 
			for other filenames, but with the leading dot removed and "___" as 
			its extension regardless of actual original extension (that's three 
			underscores).</p></li></ul></div><p>The two-digit hash value consists of upper case alphanumeric characters.</p><p>This algorithm can cause name collisions only if files 
	in a directory share the same first five alphanumeric characters. 
	The probability of such a clash is 1/1300.</p><p>The name mangling (if enabled) allows a file to be 
	copied between UNIX directories from Windows/DOS while retaining 
	the long UNIX filename. UNIX files can be renamed to a new extension 
	from Windows/DOS and will retain the same basename. Mangled names 
	do not change between sessions.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled names</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEPREFIX"></a>mangle prefix (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the number of prefix
	characters from the original name used when generating
	the mangled names. A larger value will give a weaker
	hash and therefore more name collisions. The minimum
	value is 1 and the maximum value is 6.</p><p>
	mangle prefix is effective only when mangling method is hash2.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangle prefix</tt></i> = 1
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangle prefix</tt></i> = 4
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGCHAR"></a>mangling char (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what character is used as 
	the <span class="emphasis"><em>magic</em></span> character in <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">name mangling</a>. The 
	default is a '~' but this may interfere with some software. Use this option to set 
	it to whatever you prefer. This is effective only when mangling method is hash.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling char</tt></i> = ~
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling char</tt></i> = ^
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGMETHOD"></a>mangling method (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the algorithm used for the generating
	the mangled names. Can take two different values, "hash" and
	"hash2". "hash" is the algorithm that was used
	used in Samba for many years and was the default in Samba 2.2.x "hash2" is
        now the default and is newer and considered a better algorithm (generates less collisions) in
        the names. Many Win32 applications store the mangled names and so
	changing to algorithms must not be done lightly as these applications
        may break unless reinstalled.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i> = hash2
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i> = hash
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPACLINHERIT"></a>map acl inherit (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map the 'inherit' and 'protected'
    access control entry flags stored in Windows ACLs into an extended attribute
    called user.SAMBA_PAI. This parameter only takes effect if Samba is being run
    on a platform that supports extended attributes (Linux and IRIX so far) and
    allows the Windows 2000 ACL editor to correctly use inheritance with the Samba
    POSIX ACL mapping code.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>map acl inherit</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPARCHIVE"></a>map archive (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the DOS archive attribute 
	should be mapped to the UNIX owner execute bit.  The DOS archive bit 
	is set when a file has been modified since its last backup.  One 
	motivation for this option it to keep Samba/your PC from making 
	any file it touches from becoming executable under UNIX.  This can 
	be quite annoying for shared source code, documents, etc...</p><p>Note that this requires the <i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i>
	parameter to be set such that owner execute bit is not masked out 
	(i.e. it must include 100). See the parameter <a href="#CREATEMASK">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></a> for details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>map archive</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPHIDDEN"></a>map hidden (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether DOS style hidden files 
	should be mapped to the UNIX world execute bit.</p><p>Note that this requires the <i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> 
	to be set such that the world execute bit is not masked out (i.e. 
	it must include 001). See the parameter <a href="#CREATEMASK">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></a> for details.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPSYSTEM"></a>map system (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether DOS style system files 
	should be mapped to the UNIX group execute bit.</p><p>Note that this requires the <i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> 
	to be set such that the group execute bit is not masked out (i.e. 
	it must include 010). See the parameter <a href="#CREATEMASK">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></a> for details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>map system</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPTOGUEST"></a>map to guest (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only useful in <a href="#SECURITY">
    security</a> modes other than <i class="parameter"><tt>security = share</tt></i> 
    - i.e. <tt class="constant">user</tt>, <tt class="constant">server</tt>, 
    and <tt class="constant">domain</tt>.</p><p>This parameter can take three different values, which tell
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> what to do with user 
    login requests that don't match a valid UNIX user in some way.</p><p>The three settings are :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">Never</tt> - Means user login 
	    requests with an invalid password are rejected. This is the 
	    default.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">Bad User</tt> - Means user
	    logins with an invalid password are rejected, unless the username 
	    does not exist, in which case it is treated as a guest login and 
	    mapped into the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	    guest account</tt></i></a>.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">Bad Password</tt> - Means user logins 
	    with an invalid password are treated as a guest login and mapped 
	    into the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>. Note that 
	    this can cause problems as it means that any user incorrectly typing 
	    their password will be silently logged on as "guest" - and 
	    will not know the reason they cannot access files they think
	    they should - there will have been no message given to them
	    that they got their password wrong. Helpdesk services will
	    <span class="emphasis"><em>hate</em></span> you if you set the <i class="parameter"><tt>map to 
	    guest</tt></i> parameter this way :-).</p></li></ul></div><p>Note that this parameter is needed to set up "Guest" 
    share services when using <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> modes other than 
    share. This is because in these modes the name of the resource being
    requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after 
    the server has successfully authenticated the client so the server 
    cannot make authentication decisions at the correct time (connection 
    to the share) for "Guest" shares.</p><p>For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this 
    parameter maps to the old compile-time setting of the <tt class="constant">
		GUEST_SESSSETUP</tt> value in local.h.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = Never
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = Bad User
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXCONNECTIONS"></a>max connections (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the number of simultaneous connections to a service to be limited.
    If <i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i> is greater than 0 then connections
    will be refused if this number of connections to the service are already open. A value 
    of zero mean an unlimited number of connections may be made.</p><p>Record lock files are used to implement this feature. The lock files will be stored in 
    the directory specified by the <a href="#LOCKDIRECTORY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>lock directory</tt></i></a> option.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i> = 10
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXDISKSIZE"></a>max disk size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to put an upper limit 
    on the apparent size of disks. If you set this option to 100 
    then all shares will appear to be not larger than 100 MB in 
    size.</p><p>Note that this option does not limit the amount of 
    data you can put on the disk. In the above case you could still 
    store much more than 100 MB on the disk, but if a client ever asks 
    for the amount of free disk space or the total disk size then the 
    result will be bounded by the amount specified in <i class="parameter"><tt>max 
    disk size</tt></i>.</p><p>This option is primarily useful to work around bugs 
    in some pieces of software that can't handle very large disks, 
    particularly disks over 1GB in size.</p><p>A <i class="parameter"><tt>max disk size</tt></i> of 0 means no limit.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max disk size</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max disk size</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXLOGSIZE"></a>max log size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies 
    the max size the log file should grow to. Samba periodically checks 
    the size and if it is exceeded it will rename the file, adding 
	a <tt class="filename">.old</tt> extension.</p><p>A size of 0 means no limit.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i> = 5000
</em></span>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXMUX"></a>max mux (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum number of 
    outstanding simultaneous SMB operations that Samba tells the client 
	it will allow. You should never need to set this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max mux</tt></i> = 50
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXOPENFILES"></a>max open files (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of 
    open files that one <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> file 
    serving process may have open for a client at any one time. The 
    default for this parameter is set very high (10,000) as Samba uses 
    only one bit per unopened file.</p><p>The limit of the number of open files is usually set 
    by the UNIX per-process file descriptor limit rather than 
    this parameter so you should never need to touch this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max open files</tt></i> = 10000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXPRINTJOBS"></a>max print jobs (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of 
    jobs allowable in a Samba printer queue at any given moment.
    If this number is exceeded, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will remote "Out of Space" to the client.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i> = 5000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROTOCOL"></a>protocol</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for max protocol.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXPROTOCOL"></a>max protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest 
    protocol level that will be supported by the server.</p><p>Possible values are :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">CORE</tt>: Earliest version. No 
	    concept of user names.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">COREPLUS</tt>: Slight improvements on 
	    CORE for efficiency.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">LANMAN1</tt>: First <span class="emphasis"><em>
	    modern</em></span> version of the protocol. Long filename
	    support.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">LANMAN2</tt>: Updates to Lanman1 protocol.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">NT1</tt>: Current up to date version of the protocol. 
	    Used by Windows NT. Known as CIFS.</p></li></ul></div><p>Normally this option should not be set as the automatic 
    negotiation phase in the SMB protocol takes care of choosing 
	the appropriate protocol.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max protocol</tt></i> = NT1
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max protocol</tt></i> = LANMAN1
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXREPORTEDPRINTJOBS"></a>max reported print jobs (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of 
    jobs displayed in a port monitor for Samba printer queue at any given 
    moment. If this number is exceeded, the excess jobs will not be shown.
    A value of zero means there is no limit on the number of print
	jobs reported.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max reported print jobs</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max reported print jobs</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"></a>max smbd processes (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes concurrently running on a system and is intended
    as a stopgap to prevent degrading service to clients in the event that the server has insufficient
    resources to handle more than this number of connections.  Remember that under normal operating
    conditions, each user will have an <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> associated with him or her to handle connections to all
    shares from a given host.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max smbd processes</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max smbd processes</tt></i> = 1000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXTTL"></a>max ttl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> what the default 'time to live' 
    of NetBIOS names should be (in seconds) when <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> is 
    requesting a name using either a broadcast packet or from a WINS server. You should 
	never need to change this parameter. The default is 3 days.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max ttl</tt></i> = 259200
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXWINSTTL"></a>max wins ttl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when acting as a WINS server (<a href="#WINSSUPPORT">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i></a>) what the maximum
    'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> 
    will grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this
	parameter.  The default is 6 days (518400 seconds).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max wins ttl</tt></i> = 518400
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXXMIT"></a>max xmit (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum packet size 
    that will be negotiated by Samba. The default is 65535, which 
    is the maximum. In some cases you may find you get better performance 
    with a smaller value. A value below 2048 is likely to cause problems.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i> = 65535
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i> = 8192
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MESSAGECOMMAND"></a>message command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies what command to run when the 
	server receives a WinPopup style message.</p><p>This would normally be a command that would 
	deliver the message somehow. How this is to be done is 
	up to your imagination.</p><p>An example is:</p><p><span><b class="command">message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &amp;</b></span>
	</p><p>This delivers the message using <span><b class="command">xedit</b></span>, then 
	removes it afterwards. <span class="emphasis"><em>NOTE THAT IT IS VERY IMPORTANT 
	THAT THIS COMMAND RETURN IMMEDIATELY</em></span>. That's why I 
	have the '&amp;' on the end. If it doesn't return immediately then 
	your PCs may freeze when sending messages (they should recover 
	after 30 seconds, hopefully).</p><p>All messages are delivered as the global guest user. 
	The command takes the standard substitutions, although <i class="parameter"><tt>
	%u</tt></i> won't work (<i class="parameter"><tt>%U</tt></i> may be better 
	in this case).</p><p>Apart from the standard substitutions, some additional 
	ones apply. In particular:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%s</tt></i> = the filename containing 
				the message.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%t</tt></i> = the destination that 
				the message was sent to (probably the server name).</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%f</tt></i> = who the message 
				is from.</p></li></ul></div><p>You could make this command send mail, or whatever else 
	takes your fancy. Please let us know of any really interesting 
	ideas you have.</p><p>Here's a way of sending the messages as mail to root:</p><p><span><b class="command">message command = /bin/mail -s 'message from %f on 
	%m' root &lt; %s; rm %s</b></span></p><p>If you don't have a message command then the message 
	won't be delivered and Samba will tell the sender there was 
	an error. Unfortunately WfWg totally ignores the error code 
	and carries on regardless, saying that the message was delivered.
	</p><p>If you want to silently delete it then try:</p><p><span><b class="command">message command = rm %s</b></span></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>message command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>message command</tt></i> = csh -c 'xedit %s; rm %s' &amp;
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINPASSWDLENGTH"></a>min passwd length</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for min password length.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINPASSWORDLENGTH"></a>min password length (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option sets the minimum length in characters of a
    plaintext password that <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will
    accept when performing  UNIX password changing.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>min password length</tt></i> = 5
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINPRINTSPACE"></a>min print space (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This sets the minimum amount of free disk 
    space that must be available before a user will be able to spool 
    a print job. It is specified in kilobytes. The default is 0, which 
    means a user can always spool a print job.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space</tt></i> = 2000
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINPROTOCOL"></a>min protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the 
    lowest SMB protocol dialect than Samba will support.  Please refer
    to the <a href="#MAXPROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max protocol</tt></i></a>
    parameter for a list of valid protocol names and a brief description
    of each.  You may also wish to refer to the C source code in
    <tt class="filename">source/smbd/negprot.c</tt> for a listing of known protocol
    dialects supported by clients.</p><p>If you are viewing this parameter as a security measure, you should
    also refer to the <a href="#LANMANAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>lanman 
    auth</tt></i></a> parameter.  Otherwise, you should never need 
    to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>min protocol</tt></i> = CORE
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>min protocol</tt></i> = NT1
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINWINSTTL"></a>min wins ttl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>
    when acting as a WINS server (<a href="#WINSSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    wins support = yes</tt></i></a>) what the minimum 'time to live' 
    of NetBIOS names that <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> will grant will be (in 
    seconds). You should never need to change this parameter.  The default 
    is 6 hours (21600 seconds).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>min wins ttl</tt></i> = 21600
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MSDFSPROXY"></a>msdfs proxy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter indicates that the share is a
	stand-in for another CIFS share whose location is specified by
	the value of the parameter. When clients attempt to connect to
	this share, they are redirected to the proxied share using
	the SMB-Dfs protocol.</p><p>Only Dfs roots can act as proxy shares. Take a look at the
	<a href="#MSDFSROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i></a>
	and <a href="#HOSTMSDFS"><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i></a>
	options to find out how to set up a Dfs root share.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs proxy</tt></i> = \otherserver\someshare
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MSDFSROOT"></a>msdfs root (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, Samba treats the
	share as a Dfs root and allows clients to browse the
	distributed file system tree rooted at the share directory.
	Dfs links are specified in the share directory by symbolic
	links of the form <tt class="filename">msdfs:serverA\\shareA,serverB\\shareB</tt>
	and so on.  For more information on setting up a Dfs tree on
	Samba, refer to <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"></a>name cache timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the number of seconds it takes before 
    entries in samba's hostname resolve cache time out. If 
    the timeout is set to 0. the caching is disabled.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>name cache timeout</tt></i> = 660
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>name cache timeout</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMERESOLVEORDER"></a>name resolve order (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used by the programs in the Samba 
    suite to determine what naming services to use and in what order 
    to resolve host names to IP addresses. Its main purpose to is to
    control how netbios name resolution is performed.  The option takes a space 
    separated string of name resolution options.</p><p>The options are: "lmhosts", "host",
    "wins" and "bcast". They cause names to be
    resolved as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt> : Lookup an IP 
	    address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has 
	    no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html" target="_top">lmhosts(5)</a> for details) then
	    any name type matches for lookup.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">host</tt> : Do a standard host 
	    name to IP address resolution, using the system <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts
	    </tt>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution 
	    is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or Solaris this 
	    may be controlled by the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> 
	    file.  Note that this method is used only if the NetBIOS name 
	    type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type or 0x1c (domain controllers). 
            The latter case is only useful for active directory domains and results in a DNS
            query for the SRV RR entry matching _ldap._tcp.domain.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">wins</tt> : Query a name with 
	    the IP address listed in the <a href="#WINSSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	    wins server</tt></i></a> parameter.  If no WINS server has
	    been specified this method will be ignored.</p></li><li><p><tt class="constant">bcast</tt> : Do a broadcast on 
	    each of the known local interfaces listed in the <a href="#INTERFACES"><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i></a> 
	    parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution 
	    methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally 
	    connected subnet.</p></li></ul></div><p>The example below will cause the local lmhosts file to be examined 
    first, followed by a broadcast attempt, followed by a normal 
    system hostname lookup.</p><p>When Samba is functioning in ADS security mode (<span><b class="command">security = ads</b></span>)
    it is advised to use following settings for <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>:</p><p><span><b class="command">name resolve order = wins bcast</b></span></p><p>DC lookups will still be done via DNS, but fallbacks to netbios names will
		not inundate your DNS servers with needless querys for DOMAIN&lt;0x1c&gt; lookups.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> = lmhosts host wins bcast
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> = lmhosts bcast host
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSALIASES"></a>netbios aliases (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of NetBIOS names that nmbd will 
        advertise as additional names by which the Samba server is known. This allows one machine 
	to appear in browse lists under multiple names. If a machine is acting as a browse server 
        or logon server none of these names will be advertised as either browse server or logon 
	servers, only the primary name of the machine will be advertised with these capabilities.
        </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios aliases</tt></i> = 
# empty string (no additional names)
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios aliases</tt></i> = TEST TEST1 TEST2
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSNAME"></a>netbios name (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba 
	server is known. By default it is the same as the first component 
	of the host's DNS name. If a machine is a browse server or
	logon server this name (or the first component
	of the hosts DNS name) will be the name that these services are
	advertised under.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i> = 
# machine DNS name
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i> = MYNAME
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSSCOPE"></a>netbios scope (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will 
	operate under. This should not be set unless every machine 
	on your LAN also sets this value.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios scope</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NISHOMEDIR"></a>nis homedir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For 
	UNIX systems that use an automounter, the user's home directory 
	will often be mounted on a workstation on demand from a remote 
	server. </p><p>When the Samba logon server is not the actual home directory 
	server, but is mounting the home directories via NFS then two 
	network hops would be required to access the users home directory 
	if the logon server told the client to use itself as the SMB server 
	for home directories (one over SMB and one over NFS). This can 
	be very slow.</p><p>This option allows Samba to return the home share as 
	being on a different server to the logon server and as 
	long as a Samba daemon is running on the home directory server, 
	it will be mounted on the Samba client directly from the directory 
	server. When Samba is returning the home share to the client, it 
	will consult the NIS map specified in <a href="#HOMEDIRMAP">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>homedir map</tt></i></a> and return the server 
	listed there.</p><p>Note that for this option to work there must be a working 
	NIS system and the Samba server with this option must also 
	be a logon server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>nis homedir</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTACLSUPPORT"></a>nt acl support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map 
    UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists.
    This parameter was formally a global parameter in releases
    prior to 2.2.2.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTLMAUTH"></a>ntlm auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
    authenticate users using the NTLM encrypted password response.
    If disabled, either the lanman password hash or an NTLMv2 response
    will need to be sent by the client.</p><p>If this option, and <span><b class="command">lanman
    auth</b></span> are both disabled, then only NTLMv2 logins will be
    permited.  Not all clients support NTLMv2, and most will require
	special configuration to us it.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>ntlm auth</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTPIPESUPPORT"></a>nt pipe support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether 
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will allow Windows NT 
    clients to connect to the NT SMB specific <tt class="constant">IPC$</tt> 
    pipes. This is a developer debugging option and can be left
	alone.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>nt pipe support</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTSTATUSSUPPORT"></a>nt status support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will negotiate NT specific status
    support with Windows NT/2k/XP clients. This is a developer debugging option and should be left alone.
    If this option is set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> then Samba offers
    exactly the same DOS error codes that versions prior to Samba 2.2.3
    reported.</p><p>You should not need to ever disable this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>nt status support</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NULLPASSWORDS"></a>null passwords (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Allow or disallow client access to accounts that have null passwords. </p><p>See also <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>null passwords</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"></a>obey pam restrictions (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When Samba 3.0 is configured to enable PAM support
    (i.e. --with-pam), this parameter will control whether or not Samba
    should obey PAM's account and session management directives.  The 
    default behavior is to use PAM for clear text authentication only
    and to ignore any account or session management.  Note that Samba
    always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></a>.  The reason 
    is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response
    authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB password encryption.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ONLYUSER"></a>only user (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean option that controls whether 
    connections with usernames not in the <i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> 
    list will be allowed. By default this option is disabled so that a 
    client can supply a username to be used by the server.  Enabling
    this parameter will force the server to only use the login 
    names from the <i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> list and is only really
    useful in <a href="#SECURITYEQUALSSHARE">share level</a>
    security.</p><p>Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce 
    usernames from the service name. This can be annoying for 
    the [homes] section. To get around this you could use <span><b class="command">user =
    %S</b></span> which means your <i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> list
    will be just the service name, which for home directories is the 
    name of the user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"></a>oplock break wait time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in 
	both Windows 9x and WinNT. If Samba responds to a client too 
	quickly when that client issues an SMB that can cause an oplock 
	break request, then the network client can fail and not respond 
	to the break request. This tuning parameter (which is set in milliseconds) 
	is the amount of time Samba will wait before sending an oplock break 
	request to such (broken) clients.</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND 
			UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"></a>oplock contention limit (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> advanced
	<a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> tuning option to 
	improve the efficiency of the granting of oplocks under multiple 
	client contention for the same file.</p><p>In brief it specifies a number, which causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>not to grant an oplock even when requested 
	if the approximate number of clients contending for an oplock on the same file goes over this 
	limit. This causes <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> to behave in a similar 
	way to Windows NT.</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ 
		AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i> = 2
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OPLOCKS"></a>oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean option tells <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> whether to 
	issue oplocks (opportunistic locks) to file open requests on this 
	share. The oplock code can dramatically (approx. 30% or more) improve 
	the speed of access to files on Samba servers. It allows the clients 
	to aggressively cache files locally and you may want to disable this 
	option for unreliable network environments (it is turned on by 
	default in Windows NT Servers).  For more information see the file 
	<tt class="filename">Speed.txt</tt> in the Samba <tt class="filename">docs/</tt> 
	directory.</p><p>Oplocks may be selectively turned off on certain files with a 
	share. See the <a href="#VETOOPLOCKFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	veto oplock files</tt></i></a> parameter. On some systems 
	oplocks are recognized by the underlying operating system. This 
	allows data synchronization between all access to oplocked files, 
	whether it be via Samba or NFS or a local UNIX process. See the 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks</tt></i> parameter for details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OS2DRIVERMAP"></a>os2 driver map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The parameter is used to define the absolute
    path to a file containing a mapping of Windows NT printer driver
    names to OS/2 printer driver names.  The format is:</p><p>&lt;nt driver name&gt; = &lt;os2 driver name&gt;.&lt;device name&gt;</p><p>For example, a valid entry using the HP LaserJet 5
    printer driver would appear as <span><b class="command">HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP 
    LaserJet 5L</b></span>.</p><p>The need for the file is due to the printer driver namespace 
		problem described in <a href="#">???</a>.  For more details on OS/2 clients, please 
		refer to <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OSLEVEL"></a>os level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This integer value controls what level Samba 
	advertises itself as for browse elections. The value of this 
	parameter determines whether <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> 
	has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <i class="parameter"><tt>
	WORKGROUP</tt></i> in the local broadcast area.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note :</em></span>By default, Samba will win 
	a local master browsing election over all Microsoft operating 
	systems except a Windows NT 4.0/2000 Domain Controller.  This 
	means that a misconfigured Samba host can effectively isolate 
	a subnet for browsing purposes.  See <tt class="filename">BROWSING.txt
	</tt> in the Samba <tt class="filename">docs/</tt> directory 
	for details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> = 20
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> = 65
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"></a>pam password change (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the addition of better PAM support in Samba 2.2, 
    this parameter, it is possible to use PAM's password change control 
    flag for Samba.  If enabled, then PAM will be used for password
    changes when requested by an SMB client instead of the program listed in 
    <a href="#PASSWDPROGRAM"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i></a>. 
    It should be possible to enable this without changing your 
    <a href="#PASSWDCHAT"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i></a>
	parameter for most setups.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>pam password change</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PANICACTION"></a>panic action (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a Samba developer option that allows a 
	system command to be called when either <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> or <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>	crashes. This is usually used to 
draw attention to the fact that a problem occurred.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>panic action</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>panic action</tt></i> = "/bin/sleep 90000"
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"></a>paranoid server security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest 
    users with a bad passowrd. When this option is enabled, samba will not 
    use a broken NT 4.x server as password server, but instead complain
    to the logs and exit.  
    </p><p>Disabling this option prevents Samba from making
    this check, which involves deliberatly attempting a
    bad logon to the remote server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>paranoid server security</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSDBBACKEND"></a>passdb backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the administrator to chose which backends
    to retrieve and store passwords with. This allows (for example) both 
    smbpasswd and tdbsam to be used without a recompile. Multiple
    backends can be specified, separated by spaces. The backends will be
    searched in the order they are specified. New users are always added
	to the first backend specified. </p><p>This parameter is in two parts, the backend's name, and a 'location'
    string that has meaning only to that particular backed.  These are separated
    by a : character.</p><p>Available backends can include:
	</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span><b class="command">smbpasswd</b></span> - The default smbpasswd
		backend. Takes a path to the smbpasswd file as an optional argument.
		</p></li><li><p><span><b class="command">tdbsam</b></span> - The TDB based password storage
                backend.  Takes a path to the TDB as an optional argument (defaults to passdb.tdb 
                in the <a href="#PRIVATEDIR">
                <i class="parameter"><tt>private dir</tt></i></a> directory.</p></li><li><p><span><b class="command">ldapsam</b></span> - The LDAP based passdb 
                backend.  Takes an LDAP URL as an optional argument (defaults to 
                <span><b class="command">ldap://localhost</b></span>)</p><p>LDAP connections should be secured where possible.  This may be done using either
                Start-TLS (see <a href="#LDAPSSL"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i></a>) or by
                specifying <i class="parameter"><tt>ldaps://</tt></i> in
                the URL argument. </p><p>Multiple servers may also be specified in double-quotes, if your
                LDAP libraries supports the LDAP URL notation.
                (OpenLDAP does).   
		</p></li><li><p><span><b class="command">nisplussam</b></span> -
		The NIS+ based passdb backend. Takes name NIS domain as
		an optional argument. Only works with sun NIS+ servers.
		</p></li><li><p><span><b class="command">mysql</b></span> - 
		The MySQL based passdb backend. Takes an identifier as 
		argument. Read the Samba HOWTO Collection for configuration
		details.
		</p></li></ul></div><p>
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb smbpasswd:/etc/samba/smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = ldapsam:ldaps://ldap.example.com
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = mysql:my_plugin_args tdbsam
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHAT"></a>passwd chat (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This string controls the <span class="emphasis"><em>"chat"</em></span> 
    conversation that takes places between <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and the local password changing
    program to change the user's password. The string describes a 
    sequence of response-receive pairs that <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> uses to determine what to send to the 
    <a href="#PASSWDPROGRAM"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i>
    </a> and what to expect back. If the expected output is not 
    received then the password is not changed.</p><p>This chat sequence is often quite site specific, depending 
    on what local methods are used for password control (such as NIS 
    etc).</p><p>Note that this parameter only is only used if the <a href="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"> <i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i>
    </a> parameter is set  to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. This sequence is 
    then called <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> when the SMB password  in the 
    smbpasswd file is being changed, without access to the old password
    cleartext. This means that root must be able to reset the user's password without
    knowing the text of the previous password. In the presence of
    NIS/YP,  this means that the <a href="#PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program</a> must
    be executed on the NIS master.
    </p><p>The string can contain the macro <i class="parameter"><tt>%n</tt></i> which is substituted 
    for the new password.  The chat sequence can also contain the standard 
    macros <tt class="constant">\\n</tt>, <tt class="constant">\\r</tt>, <tt class="constant">\\t</tt> and <tt class="constant">\\s</tt> to 
    give line-feed, carriage-return, tab and space.  The chat sequence string can also contain 
    a '*' which matches any sequence of characters. Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces 
    in them into a single string.</p><p>If the send string in any part of the chat sequence  is a full
    stop ".",  then no string is sent. Similarly,  if the
    expect string is a full stop then no string is expected.</p><p>If the <a href="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><i class="parameter"><tt>pam
    password change</tt></i></a> parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, the chat pairs
    may be matched in any order, and success is determined by the PAM result, 
    not any particular output. The \n macro is ignored for PAM conversions.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i> = *new*password* %n\\n*new*password* %n\\n *changed*
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i> = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\\n "*Enter NEW password*" %n\\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\\n "*Password changed*"
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"></a>passwd chat debug (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script 
    parameter is run in <span class="emphasis"><em>debug</em></span> mode. In this mode the 
    strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed 
    in the <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log with a 
    <a href="#DEBUGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i></a> 
    of 100. This is a dangerous option as it will allow plaintext passwords 
    to be seen in the <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> log. It is available to help 
    Samba admins debug their <i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i> scripts 
    when calling the <i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i> and should 
    be turned off after this has been done. This option has no effect if the 
    <a href="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><i class="parameter"><tt>pam password change</tt></i></a>
	paramter is set. This parameter is off by default.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat debug</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHATTIMEOUT"></a>passwd chat timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This integer specifies the number of seconds smbd will wait for an initial
    answer from a passwd chat script being run. Once the initial answer is received
    the subsequent answers must be received in one tenth of this time. The default it
    two seconds.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat timeout</tt></i> = 2
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDPROGRAM"></a>passwd program (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The name of a program that can be used to set 
    UNIX user passwords.  Any occurrences of <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> 
    will be replaced with the user name. The user name is checked for 
    existence before calling the password changing program.</p><p>Also note that many passwd programs insist in <span class="emphasis"><em>reasonable
    </em></span> passwords, such as a minimum length, or the inclusion 
    of mixed case chars and digits. This can pose a problem as some clients 
    (such as Windows for Workgroups) uppercase the password before sending 
    it.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that if the <i class="parameter"><tt>unix 
    password sync</tt></i> parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes
    </tt> then this program is called <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> 
    before the SMB password in the smbpasswd
    file is changed. If this UNIX password change fails, then 
    <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> will fail to change the SMB password also 
    (this is by design).</p><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i> parameter 
    is set this parameter <span class="emphasis"><em>MUST USE ABSOLUTE PATHS</em></span> 
    for <span class="emphasis"><em>ALL</em></span> programs called, and must be examined 
    for security implications. Note that by default <i class="parameter"><tt>unix 
    password sync</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">no</tt>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i> = /bin/passwd %u
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWORDLEVEL"></a>password level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Some client/server combinations have difficulty 
    with mixed-case passwords.  One offending client is Windows for 
    Workgroups, which for some reason forces passwords to upper 
    case when using the LANMAN1 protocol, but leaves them alone when 
    using COREPLUS!  Another problem child is the Windows 95/98
    family of operating systems.  These clients upper case clear
    text passwords even when NT LM 0.12 selected by the protocol
    negotiation request/response.</p><p>This parameter defines the maximum number of characters 
    that may be upper case in passwords.</p><p>For example, say the password given was "FRED". If <i class="parameter"><tt>
    password level</tt></i> is set to 1, the following combinations 
    would be tried if "FRED" failed:</p><p>"Fred", "fred", "fRed", "frEd","freD"</p><p>If <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> was set to 2, 
    the following combinations would also be tried: </p><p>"FRed", "FrEd", "FreD", "fREd", "fReD", "frED", ..</p><p>And so on.</p><p>The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely 
    it is that a mixed case password will be matched against a single 
    case password. However, you should be aware that use of this 
    parameter reduces security and increases the time taken to 
    process a new connection.</p><p>A value of zero will cause only two attempts to be 
    made - the password as is and the password in all-lower case.</p><p>This parameter is used only when using plain-text passwords. It is
    not at all used when encrypted passwords as in use (that is the default
    since samba-3.0.0). Use this only when <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    encrypt passwords = No</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> = 4
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWORDSERVER"></a>password server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>By specifying the name of another SMB server 
    or Active Directory domain controller with this option, 
    and using <span><b class="command">security = [ads|domain|server]</b></span> 
    it is possible to get Samba to 
    to do all its username/password validation using a specific remote server.</p><p>This option sets the name or IP address of the password server to use. 
    New syntax has been added to support defining the port to use when connecting 
    to the server the case of an ADS realm.  To define a port other than the
    default LDAP port of 389, add the port number using a colon after the 
    name or IP address (e.g. 192.168.1.100:389).  If you do not specify a port,
    Samba will use the standard LDAP port of tcp/389.  Note that port numbers
    have no effect on password servers for Windows NT 4.0 domains or netbios 
    connections.</p><p>If parameter is a name, it is looked up using the 
    parameter <a href="#NAMERESOLVEORDER"><i class="parameter"><tt>name 
    resolve order</tt></i></a> and so may resolved
    by any method and order described in that parameter.</p><p>The password server must be a machine capable of using 
    the "LM1.2X002" or the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, and it must be in 
    user level security mode.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Using a password server  means your UNIX box (running
    Samba) is only as secure as your  password server. <span class="emphasis"><em>DO NOT
    CHOOSE A PASSWORD SERVER THAT  YOU DON'T COMPLETELY TRUST</em></span>.
    </p></div><p>Never point a Samba server at itself for password serving.
    This will cause a loop and could lock up your Samba  server!</p><p>The name of the password server takes the standard 
    substitutions, but probably the only useful one is <i class="parameter"><tt>%m
    </tt></i>, which means the Samba server will use the incoming 
    client as the password server. If you use this then you better 
    trust your clients, and you had better restrict them with hosts allow!</p><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> parameter is set to
    <tt class="constant">domain</tt> or <tt class="constant">ads</tt>, then the list of machines in this 
    option must be a list of Primary or Backup Domain controllers for the
    Domain or the character '*', as the Samba server is effectively
    in that domain, and will use cryptographically authenticated RPC calls
    to authenticate the user logging on. The advantage of using <span><b class="command">
    security = domain</b></span> is that if you list several hosts in the 
    <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> option then <span><b class="command">smbd
    </b></span> will try each in turn till it finds one that responds.  This
    is useful in case your primary server goes down.</p><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> option is set 
    to the character '*', then Samba will attempt to auto-locate the 
    Primary or Backup Domain controllers to authenticate against by 
    doing a query for the name <tt class="constant">WORKGROUP&lt;1C&gt;</tt> 
    and then contacting each server returned in the list of IP 
    addresses from the name resolution source. </p><p>If the list of servers contains both names/IP's and the '*'
    character, the list is treated as a list of preferred 
    domain controllers, but an auto lookup of all remaining DC's
    will be added to the list as well.  Samba will not attempt to optimize 
    this list by locating the closest DC.</p><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> parameter is 
    set to <tt class="constant">server</tt>, then there are different
    restrictions that <span><b class="command">security = domain</b></span> doesn't 
    suffer from:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You may list several password servers in 
	    the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> parameter, however if an 
	    <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> makes a connection to a password server, 
	    and then the password server fails, no more users will be able 
	    to be authenticated from this <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span>.  This is a 
	    restriction of the SMB/CIFS protocol when in <span><b class="command">security = server
	    </b></span> mode and cannot be fixed in Samba.</p></li><li><p>If you are using a Windows NT server as your 
	    password server then you will have to ensure that your users 
	    are able to login from the Samba server, as when in <span><b class="command">
	    security = server</b></span>  mode the network logon will appear to 
	    come from there rather than from the users workstation.</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = NT-PDC, NT-BDC1, NT-BDC2, *
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = windc.mydomain.com:389 192.168.1.101 *
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = *
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORY"></a>directory</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for path.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PATH"></a>path (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a directory to which 
	the user of the service is to be given access. In the case of 
	printable services, this is where print data will spool prior to 
	being submitted to the host for printing.</p><p>For a printable service offering guest access, the service 
	should be readonly and the path should be world-writeable and 
	have the sticky bit set. This is not mandatory of course, but 
	you probably won't get the results you expect if you do 
	otherwise.</p><p>Any occurrences of <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> in the path 
	will be replaced with the UNIX username that the client is using 
	on this connection. Any occurrences of <i class="parameter"><tt>%m</tt></i> 
	will be replaced by the NetBIOS name of the machine they are 
	connecting from. These replacements are very useful for setting 
	up pseudo home directories for users.</p><p>Note that this path will be based on <a href="#ROOTDIR">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>root dir</tt></i></a> if one was specified.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /home/fred
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PIDDIRECTORY"></a>pid directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the directory where pid 
		files will be placed.  </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>pid directory</tt></i> = ${prefix}/var/locks
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>pid directory</tt></i> = pid directory = /var/run/
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="POSIXLOCKING"></a>posix locking (S)</span></dt><dd><p>The <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
	daemon maintains an database of file locks obtained by SMB clients.
	The default behavior is to map this internal database to POSIX
	locks.  This means that file locks obtained by SMB clients are 
	consistent with those seen by POSIX compliant applications accessing 
	the files via a non-SMB method (e.g. NFS or local file access).  
	You should never need to disable this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>posix locking</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="POSTEXEC"></a>postexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run 
	whenever the service is disconnected. It takes the usual 
	substitutions. The command may be run as the root on some 
	systems.</p><p>An interesting example may be to unmount server 
	resources:</p><p><span><b class="command">postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</b></span></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec</tt></i> = echo \"%u disconnected from %S from %m (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="EXEC"></a>exec</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for preexec.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXEC"></a>preexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever 
	the service is connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.</p><p>An interesting example is to send the users a welcome 
	message every time they log in. Maybe a message of the day? Here 
	is an example:</p><p><span><b class="command">preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" | /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' &amp; </b></span></p><p>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</p><p>See also <a href="#PREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i></a> and <a href="#POSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec
	</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i> = echo \"%u connected to %S from %m (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXECCLOSE"></a>preexec close (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero 
	return code from <a href="#PREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec
</tt></i></a> should close the service being connected to.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREFEREDMASTER"></a>prefered master</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for preferred master.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREFERREDMASTER"></a>preferred master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls if
	<a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> is a preferred master
	browser  for its workgroup.</p><p>If this is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, on startup, <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> 
	will force an election, and it will have a slight advantage in 
	winning the election.  It is recommended that this parameter is 
	used in conjunction with <span><b class="command"><a href="#DOMAINMASTER">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i></a> = yes</b></span>, so 
	that <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> can guarantee becoming a domain master.</p><p>Use this option with caution, because if there are several 
	hosts (whether Samba servers, Windows 95 or NT) that are
	preferred  master browsers on the same subnet, they will each
	periodically  and continuously attempt to become the local
	master browser. This will result in unnecessary broadcast
	traffic and reduced browsing capabilities.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> = auto
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AUTOSERVICES"></a>auto services</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for preload.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRELOAD"></a>preload (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of services that you want to be 
	automatically added to the browse lists. This is most useful 
	for homes and printers services that would otherwise not be 
	visible.</p><p>Note that if you just want all printers in your 
	printcap file loaded then the <a href="#LOADPRINTERS">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i></a> option is easier.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preload</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preload</tt></i> = fred lp colorlp
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRELOADMODULES"></a>preload modules (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of paths to modules that should
	be loaded into smbd before a client connects. This improves
	the speed of smbd when reacting to new connections somewhat. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preload modules</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preload modules</tt></i> = /usr/lib/samba/passdb/mysql.so
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRESERVECASE"></a>preserve case (S)</span></dt><dd><p> This controls if new filenames are created
	with the case that the client passes, or if they are forced to 
	be the <a href="#DEFAULTCASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default case
	</tt></i></a>.</p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a> for a fuller discussion.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTOK"></a>print ok</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for printable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTABLE"></a>printable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then 
    clients may open, write to and submit spool files on the directory 
    specified for the service. </p><p>Note that a printable service will ALWAYS allow writing 
    to the service path (user privileges permitting) via the spooling 
    of print data. The <a href="#READONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only
    </tt></i></a> parameter controls only non-printing access to 
    the resource.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCAPCACHETIME"></a>printcap cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the number of seconds before the printing
    subsystem is again asked for the known printers.  If the value
    is greater than 60 the initial waiting time is set to 60 seconds
    to allow an earlier first rescan of the printing subsystem.
    </p><p>Setting this parameter to 0 (the default) disables any 
    rescanning for new or removed printers after the initial startup.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap cache time</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap cache time</tt></i> = 600
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCAP"></a>printcap</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for printcap name.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCAPNAME"></a>printcap name (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter may be used to override the 
    compiled-in default printcap name used by the server (usually <tt class="filename">
    /etc/printcap</tt>). See the discussion of the <a href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">[printers]</a> section above for reasons 
    why you might want to do this.</p><p>To use the CUPS printing interface set <span><b class="command">printcap name = cups
    </b></span>. This should be supplemented by an addtional setting 
    <a href="#PRINTING">printing = cups</a> in the [global] 
    section.  <span><b class="command">printcap name = cups</b></span> will use the  
    "dummy" printcap created by CUPS, as specified in your CUPS
    configuration file.
    </p><p>On System V systems that use <span><b class="command">lpstat</b></span> to 
    list available printers you can use <span><b class="command">printcap name = lpstat
    </b></span> to automatically obtain lists of available printers. This 
    is the default for systems that define SYSV at configure time in 
    Samba (this includes most System V based systems). If <i class="parameter"><tt>
    printcap name</tt></i> is set to <span><b class="command">lpstat</b></span> on 
    these systems then Samba will launch <span><b class="command">lpstat -v</b></span> and 
    attempt to parse the output to obtain a printer list.</p><p>A minimal printcap file would look something like this:</p><pre class="programlisting">
print1|My Printer 1
print2|My Printer 2
print3|My Printer 3
print4|My Printer 4
print5|My Printer 5
</pre><p>where the '|' separates aliases of a printer. The fact 
    that the second alias has a space in it gives a hint to Samba 
    that it's a comment.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Under AIX the default printcap 
    name is <tt class="filename">/etc/qconfig</tt>. Samba will assume the 
    file is in AIX <tt class="filename">qconfig</tt> format if the string
	<tt class="filename">qconfig</tt> appears in the printcap filename.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i> = /etc/printcap
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i> = /etc/myprintcap
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCOMMAND"></a>print command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>After a print job has finished spooling to 
    a service, this command will be used via a <span><b class="command">system()</b></span> 
    call to process the spool file. Typically the command specified will 
    submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem, but there 
    is no requirement that this be the case. The server will not remove 
    the spool file, so whatever command you specify should remove the 
    spool file when it has been processed, otherwise you will need to 
    manually remove old spool files.</p><p>The print command is simply a text string. It will be used 
    verbatim after macro substitutions have been made:</p><p>%s, %f - the path to the spool
    file name</p><p>%p - the appropriate printer 
    name</p><p>%J - the job 
    name as transmitted by the client.</p><p>%c - The number of printed pages
    of the spooled job (if known).</p><p>%z - the size of the spooled
    print job (in bytes)</p><p>The print command <span class="emphasis"><em>MUST</em></span> contain at least 
    one occurrence of <i class="parameter"><tt>%s</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>%f
    </tt></i> - the <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is optional. At the time 
    a job is submitted, if no printer name is supplied the <i class="parameter"><tt>%p
    </tt></i> will be silently removed from the printer command.</p><p>If specified in the [global] section, the print command given 
    will be used for any printable service that does not have its own 
    print command specified.</p><p>If there is neither a specified print command for a 
    printable service nor a global print command, spool files will 
    be created but not processed and (most importantly) not removed.</p><p>Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the 
    <tt class="constant">nobody</tt> account. If this happens then create 
    an alternative guest account that can print and set the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a> 
    in the [global] section.</p><p>You can form quite complex print commands by realizing 
    that they are just passed to a shell. For example the following 
    will log a print job, print the file, then remove it. Note that 
    ';' is the usual separator for command in shell scripts.</p><p><span><b class="command">print command = echo Printing %s &gt;&gt; 
    /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</b></span></p><p>You may have to vary this command considerably depending 
    on how you normally print files on your system. The default for 
    the parameter varies depending on the setting of the <a href="#PRINTING">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: For <span><b class="command">printing = BSD, AIX, QNX, LPRNG 
    or PLP :</b></span></p><p><span><b class="command">print command = lpr -r -P%p %s</b></span></p><p>For <span><b class="command">printing = SYSV or HPUX :</b></span></p><p><span><b class="command">print command = lp -c -d%p %s; rm %s</b></span></p><p>For <span><b class="command">printing = SOFTQ :</b></span></p><p><span><b class="command">print command = lp -d%p -s %s; rm %s</b></span></p><p>For printing = CUPS :   If SAMBA is compiled against
    libcups, then <a href="#PRINTING">printcap = cups</a> 
    uses the CUPS API to
    submit jobs, etc.  Otherwise it maps to the System V
    commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it
    uses <span><b class="command">lp -c -d%p -oraw; rm %s</b></span>.   
    With <span><b class="command">printing = cups</b></span>,
    and if SAMBA is compiled against libcups, any manually 
	set print command will be ignored.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTERADMIN"></a>printer admin (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that can do anything to 
    printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC 
    (usually using a NT workstation). Note that the root user always 
	has admin rights.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = admin, @staff
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTER"></a>printer</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for printer name.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTERNAME"></a>printer name (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of the printer 
    to which print jobs spooled through a printable service will be sent.</p><p>If specified in the [global] section, the printer
    name given will be used for any printable service that does 
	not have its own printer name specified.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i> = 
# none (but may be <tt class="constant">lp</tt> on many systems)
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i> = laserwriter
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTING"></a>printing (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters controls how printer status  information is
    interpreted on your system. It also affects the  default values for
    the <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>,  <i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command </tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>, and  <i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i> if specified in the 
    [global] section.</p><p>Currently nine printing styles are supported. They are
    <tt class="constant">BSD</tt>, <tt class="constant">AIX</tt>, 
    <tt class="constant">LPRNG</tt>, <tt class="constant">PLP</tt>,
    <tt class="constant">SYSV</tt>, <tt class="constant">HPUX</tt>,
    <tt class="constant">QNX</tt>, <tt class="constant">SOFTQ</tt>,
    and <tt class="constant">CUPS</tt>.</p><p>To see what the defaults are for the other print 
    commands when using the various options use the <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> program.</p><p>This option can be set on a per printer basis.  Please be 
    aware however, that you must place any of the various printing 
    commands (e.g. print command, lpq command, etc...) after defining
    the value for the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> option since it will 
    reset the printing commands to default values.</p><p>See also the discussion in the <a href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">
    [printers]</a> section.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRIVATEDIR"></a>private dir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters defines the directory
    smbd will use for storing such files as <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt>
    and <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>private dir</tt></i> = ${prefix}/private
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROFILEACLS"></a>profile acls (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
	This boolean parameter was added to fix the problems that people have been
	having with storing user profiles on Samba shares from Windows 2000 or
	Windows XP clients. New versions of Windows 2000 or Windows XP service
	packs do security ACL checking on the owner and ability to write of the
	profile directory stored on a local workstation when copied from a Samba
	share.
</p><p>When not in domain mode with winbindd then the security info copied
	onto the local workstation has no meaning to the logged in user (SID) on
	that workstation so the profile storing fails. Adding this parameter
	onto a share used for profile storage changes two things about the
	returned Windows ACL. Firstly it changes the owner and group owner
	of all reported files and directories to be BUILTIN\\Administrators,
	BUILTIN\\Users respectively (SIDs S-1-5-32-544, S-1-5-32-545). Secondly
	it adds an ACE entry of "Full Control" to the SID BUILTIN\\Users to
	every returned ACL. This will allow any Windows 2000 or XP workstation
	user to access the profile.</p><p>Note that if you have multiple users logging
	on to a workstation then in order to prevent them from being able to access
	each others profiles you must remove the "Bypass traverse checking" advanced
	user right. This will prevent access to other users profile directories as
	the top level profile directory (named after the user) is created by the
	workstation profile code and has an ACL restricting entry to the directory
	tree to the owning user.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>profile acls</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"></a>queuepause command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be 
    executed on the server host in order to pause the printer queue.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes 
    a printer name as its only parameter and stops the printer queue, 
    such that no longer jobs are submitted to the printer.</p><p>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups, 
    but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95 
    and NT.</p><p>If a <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is given then the printer name 
    is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the command.
    </p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute 
    path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the 
	server.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i> = disable %p
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"></a>queueresume command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be 
    executed on the server host in order to resume the printer queue. It 
    is the command to undo the behavior that is caused by the 
    previous parameter (<a href="#QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    queuepause command</tt></i></a>).</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes 
    a printer name as its only parameter and resumes the printer queue, 
    such that queued jobs are resubmitted to the printer.</p><p>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups, 
    but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95 
    and NT.</p><p>If a <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is given then the printer name 
    is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the 
    command.</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute 
    path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the 
	server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command</tt></i> = enable %p
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READBMPX"></a>read bmpx (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will support the "Read
    Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used and defaults to 
    <tt class="constant">no</tt>. You should never need to set this 
	parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>read bmpx</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READLIST"></a>read list (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that are given read-only 
    access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then 
    they will not be given write access, no matter what the <a href="#READONLY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></a>
    option is set to. The list can include group names using the 
    syntax described in the <a href="#INVALIDUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>
			invalid users</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i> = mary, @students
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READONLY"></a>read only (S)</span></dt><dd><p>An inverted synonym is <a href="#WRITEABLE">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i></a>.</p><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then users 
    of a service may not create or modify files in the service's 
    directory.</p><p>Note that a printable service (<span><b class="command">printable = yes</b></span>)
    will <span class="emphasis"><em>ALWAYS</em></span> allow writing to the directory 
    (user privileges permitting), but only via spooling operations.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READRAW"></a>read raw (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not the server 
    will support the raw read SMB requests when transferring data 
    to clients.</p><p>If enabled, raw reads allow reads of 65535 bytes in 
    one packet. This typically provides a major performance benefit.
    </p><p>However, some clients either negotiate the allowable 
    block size incorrectly or are incapable of supporting larger block 
	sizes, and for these clients you may need to disable raw reads.</p><p>In general this parameter should be viewed as a system tuning 
	tool and left severely alone.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REALM"></a>realm (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the kerberos realm to use. The realm is 
	used as the ADS equivalent of the NT4 <span><b class="command">domain</b></span>. It
	is usually set to the DNS name of the kerberos server.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>realm</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>realm</tt></i> = mysambabox.mycompany.com
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REMOTEANNOUNCE"></a>remote announce (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>to periodically announce itself 
	to arbitrary IP addresses with an arbitrary workgroup name.</p><p>This is useful if you want your Samba server to appear 
	in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse propagation 
	rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere that you 
	can send IP packets to.</p><p>For example:</p><p><span><b class="command">remote announce = 192.168.2.255/SERVERS 
	192.168.4.255/STAFF</b></span></p><p>the above line would cause <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to announce itself 
	to the two given IP addresses using the given workgroup names. 
	If you leave out the workgroup name then the one given in 
	the <a href="#WORKGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i></a> 
	parameter is used instead.</p><p>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast 
	addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses 
	of known browse masters if your network config is that stable.</p><p>See <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"></a>remote browse sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to periodically request 
	synchronization of browse lists with the master browser of a Samba 
	server that is on a remote segment. This option will allow you to 
	gain browse lists for multiple workgroups across routed networks. This 
	is done in a manner that does not work with any non-Samba servers.</p><p>This is useful if you want your Samba server and all local 
	clients to appear in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse 
	propagation rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere 
	that you can send IP packets to.</p><p>For example:</p><p><span><b class="command">remote browse sync = 192.168.2.255 192.168.4.255</b></span></p><p>the above line would cause <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to request 
	the master browser on the specified subnets or addresses to 
	synchronize their browse lists with the local server.</p><p>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast 
	addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses 
	of known browse masters if your network config is that stable. If 
	a machine IP address is given Samba makes NO attempt to validate 
	that the remote machine is available, is listening, nor that it 
	is in fact the browse master on its segment.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="RESTRICTANONYMOUS"></a>restrict anonymous (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The setting of this parameter determines whether user and
    group list information is returned for an anonymous connection.
    and mirrors the effects of the
    <tt class="constant">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\LSA\RestrictAnonymous</tt> registry key in Windows
    2000 and Windows NT.  When set to 0, user and group list
    information is returned to anyone who asks.  When set
    to 1, only an authenticated user can retrive user and
    group list information.  For the value 2, supported by
    Windows 2000/XP and Samba, no anonymous connections are allowed at
    all.  This can break third party and Microsoft
    applications which expect to be allowed to perform
	operations anonymously.</p><p>
    The security advantage of using restrict anonymous = 1 is dubious,
    as user and group list information can be obtained using other
	means.
	</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
    The security advantage of using restrict anonymous = 2 is removed
    by setting <a href="#GUESTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest
	ok</tt></i> = yes</a> on any share.
	</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>restrict anonymous</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOT"></a>root</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for root directory.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTDIR"></a>root dir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for root directory.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTDIRECTORY"></a>root directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The server will <span><b class="command">chroot()</b></span> (i.e. 
    Change its root directory) to this directory on startup. This is 
    not strictly necessary for secure operation. Even without it the 
    server will deny access to files not in one of the service entries. 
    It may also check for, and deny access to, soft links to other 
    parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use ".." in file names 
    to access other directories (depending on the setting of the <a href="#WIDELINKS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i></a> 
    parameter).
    </p><p>Adding a <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> entry other 
    than "/" adds an extra level of security, but at a price. It 
    absolutely ensures that no access is given to files not in the 
    sub-tree specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> 
    option, <span class="emphasis"><em>including</em></span> some files needed for 
    complete operation of the server. To maintain full operability 
    of the server you will need to mirror some system files 
    into the <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> tree. In particular 
    you will need to mirror <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> (or a 
    subset of it), and any binaries or configuration files needed for 
    printing (if required). The set of files that must be mirrored is
    operating system dependent.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> = /
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> = /homes/smb
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTPOSTEXEC"></a>root postexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the same as the <i class="parameter"><tt>postexec</tt></i>
	parameter except that the command is run as root. This 
	is useful for unmounting filesystems 
	(such as CDROMs) after a connection is closed.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>root postexec</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTPREEXEC"></a>root preexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the same as the <i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i>
	parameter except that the command is run as root. This 
	is useful for mounting filesystems (such as CDROMs) when a 
	connection is opened.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"></a>root preexec close (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the same as the <i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close
	</tt></i> parameter except that the command is run as root.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec close</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SECURITY"></a>security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option affects how clients respond to 
    Samba and is one of the most important settings in the <tt class="filename">
    smb.conf</tt> file.</p><p>The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to 
    protocol negotiations with <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide 
    based on this bit whether (and how) to transfer user and password 
    information to the server.</p><p>The default is <span><b class="command">security = user</b></span>, as this is
    the most common setting needed when talking to Windows 98 and 
    Windows NT.</p><p>The alternatives are <span><b class="command">security = share</b></span>,
    <span><b class="command">security = server</b></span> or <span><b class="command">security = domain
    </b></span>.</p><p>In versions of Samba prior to 2.0.0, the default was 
    <span><b class="command">security = share</b></span> mainly because that was
    the only option at one stage.</p><p>There is a bug in WfWg that has relevance to this 
    setting. When in user or server level security a WfWg client 
    will totally ignore the password you type in the "connect 
    drive" dialog box. This makes it very difficult (if not impossible) 
    to connect to a Samba service as anyone except the user that 
    you are logged into WfWg as.</p><p>If your PCs use usernames that are the same as their 
    usernames on the UNIX machine then you will want to use 
    <span><b class="command">security = user</b></span>. If you mostly use usernames 
    that don't exist on the UNIX box then use <span><b class="command">security = 
    share</b></span>.</p><p>You should also use <span><b class="command">security = share</b></span> if you 
    want to mainly setup shares without a password (guest shares). This 
    is commonly used for a shared printer server. It is more difficult 
    to setup guest shares with <span><b class="command">security = user</b></span>, see 
    the <a href="#MAPTOGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>
    </a>parameter for details.</p><p>It is possible to use <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> in a <span class="emphasis"><em>
    hybrid mode</em></span> where it is offers both user and share 
    level security under different <a href="#NETBIOSALIASES">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS aliases</tt></i></a>. </p><p>The different settings will now be explained.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = SHARE</em></span></p><p>When clients connect to a share level security server they 
    need not log onto the server with a valid username and password before 
    attempting to connect to a shared resource (although modern clients 
    such as Windows 95/98 and Windows NT will send a logon request with 
    a username but no password when talking to a <span><b class="command">security = share
    </b></span> server). Instead, the clients send authentication information 
    (passwords) on a per-share basis, at the time they attempt to connect 
    to that share.</p><p>Note that <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> <span class="emphasis"><em>ALWAYS</em></span> 
    uses a valid UNIX user to act on behalf of the client, even in
    <span><b class="command">security = share</b></span> level security.</p><p>As clients are not required to send a username to the server
    in share level security, <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> uses several
    techniques to determine the correct UNIX user to use on behalf
    of the client.</p><p>A list of possible UNIX usernames to match with the given
    client password is constructed using the following methods :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>If the <a href="#GUESTONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest 
	    only</tt></i></a> parameter is set, then all the other 
	    stages are missed and only the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">
	    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a> username is checked.
	    </p></li><li><p>Is a username is sent with the share connection 
	    request, then this username (after mapping - see <a href="#USERNAMEMAP">
	    <i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i></a>), 
	    is added as a potential username.
	    </p></li><li><p>If the client did a previous <span class="emphasis"><em>logon
	    </em></span> request (the SessionSetup SMB call) then the 
	    username sent in this SMB will be added as a potential username.
	    </p></li><li><p>The name of the service the client requested is 
	    added as a potential username.
	    </p></li><li><p>The NetBIOS name of the client is added to 
	    the list as a potential username.
	    </p></li><li><p>Any users on the <a href="#USER"><i class="parameter"><tt>
	    user</tt></i></a> list are added as potential usernames.
	    </p></li></ul></div><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest only</tt></i> parameter is 
    not set, then this list is then tried with the supplied password. 
    The first user for whom the password matches will be used as the 
    UNIX user.</p><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest only</tt></i> parameter is 
    set, or no username can be determined then if the share is marked 
    as available to the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>, then this 
    guest user will be used, otherwise access is denied.</p><p>Note that it can be <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> confusing 
    in share-level security as to which UNIX username will eventually
    be used in granting access.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
    NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = USER</em></span></p><p>This is the default security setting in Samba 3.0. 
    With user-level security a client must first "log-on" with a 
    valid username and password (which can be mapped using the <a href="#USERNAMEMAP">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i></a> 
    parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i></a> parameter) can also
    be used in this security mode. Parameters such as <a href="#USER">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i></a> and <a href="#GUESTONLY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest only</tt></i></a> if set	are then applied and 
    may change the UNIX user to use on this connection, but only after 
    the user has been successfully authenticated.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that the name of the resource being 
    requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after 
    the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why 
    guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing 
    the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a>. 
    See the <a href="#MAPTOGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>
    </a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
    NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = DOMAIN</em></span></p><p>This mode will only work correctly if <a href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a> has been used to add this
    machine into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i>
    </a> parameter to be set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. In this 
    mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by passing
    it to a Windows NT Primary or Backup Domain Controller, in exactly 
    the same way that a Windows NT Server would do.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that a valid UNIX user must still 
    exist as well as the account on the Domain Controller to allow 
    Samba to have a valid UNIX account to map file access to.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that from the client's point 
    of view <span><b class="command">security = domain</b></span> is the same 
    as <span><b class="command">security = user</b></span>. It only 
    affects how the server deals with the authentication, 
    it does not in any way affect what the client sees.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that the name of the resource being 
    requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after 
    the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why 
    guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing 
    the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a>. 
    See the <a href="#MAPTOGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>
    </a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
    NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a href="#PASSWORDSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>password 
    server</tt></i></a> parameter and the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i>
    </a> parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = SERVER</em></span></p><p>In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password 
    by passing it to another SMB server, such as an NT box. If this 
    fails it will revert to <span><b class="command">security =
    user</b></span>. It expects the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i></a> parameter 
    to be set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, unless the remote server
    does not support them.  However note that if encrypted passwords have been 
    negotiated then Samba cannot revert back to checking the UNIX password file, 
    it must have a valid <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file to check 
	users against. See the chapter about the User Database in the Samba HOWTO Collection for details on how to set this up.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This mode of operation has
    significant pitfalls, due to the fact that is activly initiates a
    man-in-the-middle attack on the remote SMB server.  In particular,
    this mode of operation can cause significant resource consuption on
    the PDC, as it must maintain an active connection for the duration
    of the user's session.  Furthermore, if this connection is lost,
    there is no way to reestablish it, and futher authenticaions to the
    Samba server may fail.  (From a single client, till it disconnects).
	</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>From the client's point of 
    view <span><b class="command">security = server</b></span> is the
    same as <span><b class="command">security = user</b></span>.  It
    only affects how the server deals  with the authentication, it does
	not in any way affect what the  client sees.</p></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that the name of the resource being 
    requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after 
    the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why 
    guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing 
    the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a>. 
    See the <a href="#MAPTOGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>
    </a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
    NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a href="#PASSWORDSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>password 
    server</tt></i></a> parameter and the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSADS"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = ADS</em></span></p><p>In this mode, Samba will act as a domain member in an ADS realm. To operate 
		in this mode, the machine running Samba will need to have Kerberos installed 
		and configured and Samba will need to be joined to the ADS realm using the 
		net utility. </p><p>Note that this mode does NOT make Samba operate as a Active Directory Domain 
		Controller. </p><p>Read the chapter about Domain Membership in the HOWTO for details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = USER
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = DOMAIN
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SECURITYMASK"></a>security mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission 
    bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating 
    the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security 
    dialog box.</p><p>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to 
    the changed permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in 
    this mask from being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this 
    mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is not allowed 
    to change.</p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is 0777, allowing
    a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file.
    </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access the 
    Samba server through other means can easily bypass this 
    restriction, so it is primarily useful for standalone 
    "appliance" systems.  Administrators of most normal systems will 
	probably want to leave it set to <tt class="constant">0777</tt>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> = 0777
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> = 0770
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSCHANNEL"></a>server schannel (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the server offers or even
    demands the use of the netlogon schannel.
    <i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel = no</tt></i> does not
    offer the schannel, <i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel =
    auto</tt></i> offers the schannel but does not
    enforce it, and <i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel =
    yes</tt></i> denies access if the client is not
    able to speak netlogon schannel. This is only the case
    for Windows NT4 before SP4.</p><p>Please note that with this set to
    <i class="parameter"><tt>no</tt></i> you will have to apply the
    WindowsXP requireSignOrSeal-Registry patch found in
	the docs/Registry subdirectory.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel</tt></i> = auto
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSIGNING"></a>server signing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the server offers or requires
    the client it talks to to use SMB signing. Possible values 
    are <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>mandatory</em></span> 
    and <span class="emphasis"><em>disabled</em></span>. 
    </p><p>When set to auto, SMB signing is offered, but not enforced. 
    When set to mandatory, SMB signing is required and if set 
	to disabled, SMB signing is not offered either.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>server signing</tt></i> = Disabled
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSTRING"></a>server string (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in print 
        manager and next to the IPC connection in <span><b class="command">net view</b></span>. It 
        can be any string that you wish to show to your users.</p><p>It also sets what will appear in browse lists next 
	to the machine name.</p><p>A <i class="parameter"><tt>%v</tt></i> will be replaced with the Samba 
	version number.</p><p>A <i class="parameter"><tt>%h</tt></i> will be replaced with the 
		hostname.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>server string</tt></i> = Samba %v
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>server string</tt></i> = University of GNUs Samba Server
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETDIRECTORY"></a>set directory (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If <span><b class="command">set directory = no</b></span>, then 
	users of the service may not use the setdir command to change 
	directory.</p><p>The <span><b class="command">setdir</b></span> command is only implemented 
	in the Digital Pathworks client. See the Pathworks documentation 
	for details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>set directory</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETPRIMARYGROUPSCRIPT"></a>set primary group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Thanks to the Posix subsystem in NT a Windows User has a
	primary group in addition to the auxiliary groups.  This script
	sets the primary group in the unix userdatase when an
	administrator sets the primary group from the windows user
	manager or when fetching a SAM with <span><b class="command">net rpc
	vampire</b></span>. <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> will be replaced
	with the user whose primary group is to be set. 
	<i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> will be replaced with the group to
	set.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>set primary group script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>set primary group script</tt></i> = /usr/sbin/usermod -g '%g' '%u'
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETQUOTACOMMAND"></a>set quota command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <span><b class="command">set quota command</b></span> should only be used 
	whenever there is no operating system API available from the OS that 
	samba can use.</p><p>This option is only available if Samba was configured with the argument <span><b class="command">--with-sys-quotas</b></span> or 
	on linux when <span><b class="command">./configure --with-quotas</b></span> was used and a working quota api 
	was found in the system. Most packages are configured with these options already.</p><p>This parameter should specify the path to a script that 
	can set quota for the specified arguments.</p><p>The specified script should take the following arguments:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>1 - quota type
			</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>1 - user quotas</p></li><li><p>2 - user default quotas (uid = -1)</p></li><li><p>3 - group quotas</p></li><li><p>4 - group default quotas (gid = -1)</p></li></ul></div><p>
			</p></li><li><p>2 - id (uid for user, gid for group, -1 if N/A)</p></li><li><p>3 - quota state (0 = disable, 1 = enable, 2 = enable and enforce)</p></li><li><p>4 - block softlimit</p></li><li><p>5 - block hardlimit</p></li><li><p>6 - inode softlimit</p></li><li><p>7 - inode hardlimit</p></li><li><p>8(optional) - block size, defaults to 1024</p></li></ul></div><p>The script should output at least one line of data on success. And nothing on failure.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>set quota command</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>set quota command</tt></i> = /usr/local/sbin/set_quota
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHAREMODES"></a>share modes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This enables or disables the honoring of 
	the <i class="parameter"><tt>share modes</tt></i> during a file open. These 
	modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or write access 
	to a file.</p><p>These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so
	they are simulated using shared memory, or lock files if your 
	UNIX doesn't support shared memory (almost all do).</p><p>The share modes that are enabled by this option are 
	<tt class="constant">DENY_DOS</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_ALL</tt>,
	<tt class="constant">DENY_READ</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_WRITE</tt>,
	<tt class="constant">DENY_NONE</tt> and <tt class="constant">DENY_FCB</tt>.
	</p><p>This option gives full share compatibility and enabled 
	by default.</p><p>You should <span class="emphasis"><em>NEVER</em></span> turn this parameter 
	off as many Windows applications will break if you do so.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>share modes</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHORTPRESERVECASE"></a>short preserve case (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls if new files 
	which conform to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of 
	suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced 
	to be the <a href="#DEFAULTCASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default case
	</tt></i></a>. This  option can be use with <a href="#PRESERVECASE"><span><b class="command">preserve case = yes</b></span>
	</a> to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short 
	names are lowered. </p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"></a>show add printer wizard (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support
    for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will 
    appear on Samba hosts in the share listing.  Normally this folder will 
    contain an icon for the MS Add Printer Wizard (APW).  However, it is 
    possible to disable this feature regardless of the level of privilege 
    of the connected user.</p><p>Under normal circumstances, the Windows NT/2000 client will 
    open a handle on the printer server with OpenPrinterEx() asking for
    Administrator privileges.  If the user does not have administrative
    access on the print server (i.e is not root or a member of the 
    <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> group), the OpenPrinterEx() 
    call fails and the client makes another open call with a request for 
    a lower privilege level.  This should succeed, however the APW 
    icon will not be displayed.</p><p>Disabling the <i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i>
    parameter will always cause the OpenPrinterEx() on the server
	to fail.  Thus the APW icon will never be displayed. 
</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This does not prevent the same user from having 
		administrative privilege on an individual printer.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a>shutdown script (G)</span></dt><dd><p><span class="emphasis"><em>This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</em></span>
	This a full path name to a script called by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that should start a shutdown procedure.</p><p>This command will be run as the user connected to the server.</p><p>%m %t %r %f parameters are expanded:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%m</tt></i> will be substituted with the
			shutdown message sent to the server.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%t</tt></i> will be substituted with the
			number of seconds to wait before effectively starting the
			shutdown procedure.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%r</tt></i> will be substituted with the
			switch <span class="emphasis"><em>-r</em></span>. It means reboot after shutdown
			for NT.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%f</tt></i> will be substituted with the
			switch <span class="emphasis"><em>-f</em></span>. It means force the shutdown
			even if applications do not respond for NT.</p></li></ul></div><p>Shutdown script example:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
#!/bin/bash
		
$time=0
let "time/60"
let "time++"

/sbin/shutdown $3 $4 +$time $1 &amp;
</pre><p>
Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/sbin/shutdown %m %t %r %f
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SMBPASSWDFILE"></a>smb passwd file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option sets the path to the encrypted smbpasswd file. By
    default the path to the smbpasswd file  is compiled into Samba.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>smb passwd file</tt></i> = ${prefix}/private/smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>smb passwd file</tt></i> = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SMBPORTS"></a>smb ports (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies which ports the server should listen on for SMB traffic.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>smb ports</tt></i> = 445 139
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SOCKETADDRESS"></a>socket address (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to control what 
	address Samba will listen for connections on. This is used to 
	support multiple virtual interfaces on the one server, each 
	with a different configuration.</p><p>By default Samba will accept connections on any 
		address.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>socket address</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>socket address</tt></i> = 192.168.2.20
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SOCKETOPTIONS"></a>socket options (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to set socket options 
    to be used when talking with the client.</p><p>Socket options are controls on the networking layer 
    of the operating systems which allow the connection to be 
    tuned.</p><p>This option will typically be used to tune your Samba  server
    for optimal performance for your local network. There is  no way
    that Samba can know what the optimal parameters are for  your net,
    so you must experiment and choose them yourself. We  strongly
    suggest you read the appropriate documentation for your  operating
    system first (perhaps <span><b class="command">man
    setsockopt</b></span> will help).</p><p>You may find that on some systems Samba will say 
    "Unknown socket option" when you supply an option. This means you 
    either incorrectly  typed it or you need to add an include file 
    to includes.h for your OS.  If the latter is the case please 
    send the patch to <a href="mailto:samba-technical@samba.org" target="_top">
    samba-technical@samba.org</a>.</p><p>Any of the supported socket options may be combined 
    in any way you like, as long as your OS allows it.</p><p>This is the list of socket options currently settable 
    using this option:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>SO_KEEPALIVE</p></li><li><p>SO_REUSEADDR</p></li><li><p>SO_BROADCAST</p></li><li><p>TCP_NODELAY</p></li><li><p>IPTOS_LOWDELAY</p></li><li><p>IPTOS_THROUGHPUT</p></li><li><p>SO_SNDBUF *</p></li><li><p>SO_RCVBUF *</p></li><li><p>SO_SNDLOWAT *</p></li><li><p>SO_RCVLOWAT *</p></li></ul></div><p>Those marked with a <span class="emphasis"><em>'*'</em></span> take an integer 
    argument. The others can optionally take a 1 or 0 argument to enable 
    or disable the option, by default they will be enabled if you 
    don't specify 1 or 0.</p><p>To specify an argument use the syntax SOME_OPTION = VALUE 
    for example <span><b class="command">SO_SNDBUF = 8192</b></span>. Note that you must 
    not have any spaces before or after the = sign.</p><p>If you are on a local network then a sensible option 
    might be:</p><p><span><b class="command">socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</b></span></p><p>If you have a local network then you could try:</p><p><span><b class="command">socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY TCP_NODELAY</b></span></p><p>If you are on a wide area network then perhaps try 
    setting IPTOS_THROUGHPUT. </p><p>Note that several of the options may cause your Samba 
		server to fail completely. Use these options with caution!</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> = TCP_NODELAY
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> = IPTOS_LOWDELAY
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STATCACHE"></a>stat cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will use a cache in order to 
	speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should never need 
	to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>stat cache</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STOREDOSATTRIBUTES"></a>store dos attributes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is set Samba no longer attempts to
	map DOS attributes like SYSTEM, HIDDEN, ARCHIVE or READ-ONLY
	to UNIX permission bits (such as the <a href="#MAPHIDDEN"><i class="parameter"><tt>map hidden</tt></i></a>. Instead, DOS attributes will be stored onto an extended
	attribute in the UNIX filesystem, associated with the file or directory.
	For this to operate correctly, the parameters <a href="#MAPHIDDEN"><i class="parameter"><tt>map hidden</tt></i></a>, <a href="#MAPSYSTEM"><i class="parameter"><tt>map system</tt></i></a>, <a href="#MAPARCHIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>map archive</tt></i></a> must be set to off.
	This parameter writes the DOS attributes as a string into the
	extended attribute named "user.DOSATTRIB". This extended attribute
	is explicitly hidden from smbd clients requesting an EA list.
	On Linux the filesystem must have been mounted with the mount
	option user_xattr in order for extended attributes to work, also
	extended attributes must be compiled into the Linux kernel.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>store dos attributes</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTALLOCATE"></a>strict allocate (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of 
    disk space allocation in the server. When this is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> 
    the server will change from UNIX behaviour of not committing real
    disk storage blocks when a file is extended to the Windows behaviour
    of actually forcing the disk system to allocate real storage blocks
    when a file is created or extended to be a given size. In UNIX
    terminology this means that Samba will stop creating sparse files.
    This can be slow on some systems.</p><p>When strict allocate is <tt class="constant">no</tt> the server does sparse
    disk block allocation when a file is extended.</p><p>Setting this to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> can help Samba return
    out of quota messages on systems that are restricting the disk quota
    of users.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>strict allocate</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTLOCKING"></a>strict locking (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of 
	file locking in the server. When this is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>,
	the server will check every read and write access for file locks, and 
	deny access if locks exist. This can be slow on some systems.</p><p>When strict locking is disabled, the server performs file 
	lock checks only when the client explicitly asks for them.</p><p>Well-behaved clients always ask for lock checks when it 
	is important.  So in the vast majority of cases, <span><b class="command">strict 
	locking = no</b></span> is preferable.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTSYNC"></a>strict sync (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Many Windows applications (including the Windows 98 explorer
    shell) seem to confuse flushing buffer contents to disk with doing
    a sync to disk. Under UNIX, a sync call forces the process to be
    suspended until the kernel has ensured that all outstanding data in
    kernel disk buffers has been safely stored onto stable storage.
    This is very slow and should only be done rarely. Setting this
    parameter to <tt class="constant">no</tt> (the default) means that
    <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> ignores the Windows
    applications requests for a sync call. There is only a possibility
    of losing data if the operating system itself that Samba is running
    on crashes, so there is little danger in this default setting. In
    addition, this fixes many performance problems that people have
    reported with the new Windows98 explorer shell file copies.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>strict sync</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SYNCALWAYS"></a>sync always (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean parameter that controls 
    whether writes will always be written to stable storage before 
    the write call returns. If this is <tt class="constant">no</tt> then the server will be 
    guided by the client's request in each write call (clients can 
    set a bit indicating that a particular write should be synchronous). 
    If this is <tt class="constant">yes</tt> then every write will be followed by a <span><b class="command">fsync()
    </b></span> call to ensure the data is written to disk. Note that 
    the <i class="parameter"><tt>strict sync</tt></i> parameter must be set to
    <tt class="constant">yes</tt> in order for this parameter to have 
    any affect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>sync always</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SYSLOG"></a>syslog (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter maps how Samba debug messages 
    are logged onto the system syslog logging levels. Samba debug 
    level zero maps onto syslog <tt class="constant">LOG_ERR</tt>, debug 
    level one maps onto <tt class="constant">LOG_WARNING</tt>, debug level 
    two maps onto <tt class="constant">LOG_NOTICE</tt>, debug level three 
    maps onto LOG_INFO. All higher levels are mapped to <tt class="constant">
    LOG_DEBUG</tt>.</p><p>This parameter sets the threshold for sending messages 
    to syslog.  Only messages with debug level less than this value 
    will be sent to syslog.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>syslog</tt></i> = 1
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SYSLOGONLY"></a>syslog only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is set then Samba debug 
    messages are logged into the system syslog only, and not to 
	the debug log files.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>syslog only</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"></a>template homedir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT 
	user, the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon  uses this
	parameter to fill in the home directory for that user. If the
	string <i class="parameter"><tt>%D</tt></i> is present it
	is substituted  with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the
	string <i class="parameter"><tt>%U</tt></i> is present it
	is substituted with the user's Windows  NT user name.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i> = /home/%D/%U
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATEPRIMARYGROUP"></a>template primary group (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option defines the default primary group for 
	each user created by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>'s local account management
	functions (similar to the 'add user script').
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>template primary group</tt></i> = nobody
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATESHELL"></a>template shell (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT 
	user, the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon uses this
	parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMEOFFSET"></a>time offset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add 
	to the normal GMT to local time conversion. This is useful if 
	you are serving a lot of PCs that have incorrect daylight 
	saving time handling.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>time offset</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>time offset</tt></i> = 60
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMESERVER"></a>time server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> advertises itself as a time server to Windows 
clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>time server</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXCHARSET"></a>unix charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the charset the unix machine 
		Samba runs on uses. Samba needs to know this in order to be able to 
		convert text to the charsets other SMB clients use.
	</p><p>This is also the charset Samba will use when specifying arguments 
		to scripts that it invokes.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = UTF8
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = ASCII
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXEXTENSIONS"></a>unix extensions (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba 
    implments the CIFS UNIX extensions, as defined by HP. 
    These extensions enable Samba to better serve UNIX CIFS clients
    by supporting features such as symbolic links, hard links, etc...
    These extensions require a similarly enabled client, and are of
    no current use to Windows clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>unix extensions</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"></a>unix password sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba 
    attempts to synchronize the UNIX password with the SMB password 
    when the encrypted SMB password in the smbpasswd file is changed. 
    If this is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> the program specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>passwd
    program</tt></i>parameter is called <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> - 
    to allow the new UNIX password to be set without access to the 
    old UNIX password (as the SMB password change code has no 
	access to the old password cleartext, only the new).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UPDATEENCRYPTED"></a>update encrypted (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter allows a user logging on with
    a plaintext password to have their encrypted (hashed) password in
    the smbpasswd file to be updated automatically as they log
    on. This option allows a site to migrate from plaintext  	
    password authentication (users authenticate with plaintext  	
    password over the wire, and are checked against a UNIX account  	
    database) to encrypted password authentication (the SMB  	
    challenge/response authentication mechanism) without forcing all
    users to re-enter their passwords via smbpasswd at the time the 	
    change is made. This is a convenience option to allow the change
    over to encrypted passwords to be made over a longer period.
    Once all users have encrypted representations of their passwords
    in the smbpasswd file this parameter should be set to
    <tt class="constant">no</tt>.</p><p>In order for this parameter to work correctly the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i></a> parameter must 
    be set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> when this parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>.</p><p>Note that even when this parameter is set a user 
    authenticating to <span><b class="command">smbd</b></span> must still enter a valid 
    password in order to connect correctly, and to update their hashed 
	(smbpasswd) passwords.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>update encrypted</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USECLIENTDRIVER"></a>use client driver (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter applies only to Windows NT/2000
    clients.  It has no effect on Windows 95/98/ME clients.  When 
    serving a printer to Windows NT/2000 clients without first installing
    a valid printer driver on the Samba host, the client will be required
    to install a local printer driver.  From this point on, the client
    will treat the print as a local printer and not a network printer 
    connection.  This is much the same behavior that will occur
    when <span><b class="command">disable spoolss = yes</b></span>.
    </p><p>The differentiating  factor is that under normal
    circumstances, the NT/2000 client will  attempt to open the network
    printer using MS-RPC.  The problem is that because the client
    considers the printer to be local, it will attempt to issue the
    OpenPrinterEx() call requesting access rights associated  with the
    logged on user. If the user possesses local administator rights but
    not root privilegde on the Samba host (often the case), the
    OpenPrinterEx() call will fail.  The result is that the client will
    now display an "Access Denied; Unable to connect" message
    in the printer queue window (even though jobs may successfully be
    printed).  </p><p>If this parameter is enabled for a printer, then any attempt
    to open the printer with the PRINTER_ACCESS_ADMINISTER right is mapped
    to PRINTER_ACCESS_USE instead.  Thus allowing the OpenPrinterEx()
    call to succeed.  <span class="emphasis"><em>This parameter MUST not be able enabled
    on a print share which has valid print driver installed on the Samba 
	server.</em></span></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USEKERBEROSKEYTAB"></a>use kerberos keytab (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
Specifies whether Samba should attempt to maintain service principals in the systems
keytab file for <tt class="constant">host/FQDN</tt> and <tt class="constant">cifs/FQDN</tt>.
</p><p>When you are using the heimdal Kerberos libraries, you must also 
specify the following in <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt>:</p><pre class="programlisting">
[libdefaults]
  default_keytab_name = FILE:/etc/krb5.keytab
</pre><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>use kerberos keytab</tt></i> = False
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USEMMAP"></a>use mmap (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This global parameter determines if the tdb internals of Samba can
    depend on mmap working correctly on the running system. Samba requires a coherent
    mmap/read-write system memory cache. Currently only HPUX does not have such a
    coherent cache, and so this parameter is set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> by
    default on HPUX. On all other systems this parameter should be left alone. This
    parameter is provided to help the Samba developers track down problems with
    the tdb internal code.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>use mmap</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USER"></a>user</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for username.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERS"></a>users</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for username.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAME"></a>username (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited 
    list, in which case the supplied password will be tested against 
    each username in turn (left to right).</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> line is needed only when 
    the PC is unable to supply its own username. This is the case 
    for the COREPLUS protocol or where your users have different WfWg 
    usernames to UNIX usernames. In both these cases you may also be 
    better using the \\server\share%user syntax instead.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> line is not a great 
    solution in many cases as it means Samba will try to validate 
    the supplied password against each of the usernames in the 
    <i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> line in turn. This is slow and 
    a bad idea for lots of users in case of duplicate passwords. 
    You may get timeouts or security breaches using this parameter 
    unwisely.</p><p>Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This 
    parameter does not restrict who can login, it just offers hints 
    to the Samba server as to what usernames might correspond to the 
    supplied password. Users can login as whoever they please and 
    they will be able to do no more damage than if they started a 
    telnet session. The daemon runs as the user that they log in as, 
    so they cannot do anything that user cannot do.</p><p>To restrict a service to a particular set of users you 
    can use the <a href="#VALIDUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users
    </tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '@' then the name 
    will be looked up first in the NIS netgroups list (if Samba 
    is compiled with netgroup support), followed by a lookup in 
    the UNIX groups database and will expand to a list of all users 
    in the group of that name.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '+' then the name 
    will be looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will 
    expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '&amp;' then the name 
    will be looked up only in the NIS netgroups database (if Samba 
    is compiled with netgroup support) and will expand to a list 
    of all users in the netgroup group of that name.</p><p>Note that searching though a groups database can take 
    quite some time, and some clients may time out during the 
    search.</p><p>See the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">NOTE ABOUT 
    USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a> for more information on how 
this parameter determines access to the services.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> = 
# The guest account if a guest service, 
		else &lt;empty string&gt;.
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> = fred, mary, jack, jane, @users, @pcgroup
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAMELEVEL"></a>username level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at 
    the real UNIX username, as many DOS clients send an all-uppercase 
    username. By default Samba tries all lowercase, followed by the 
    username with the first letter capitalized, and fails if the 
    username is not found on the UNIX machine.</p><p>If this parameter is set to non-zero the behavior changes. 
    This parameter is a number that specifies the number of uppercase
    combinations to try while trying to determine the UNIX user name. The
    higher the number the more combinations will be tried, but the slower
    the discovery of usernames will be. Use this parameter when you have
    strange usernames on your UNIX machine, such as <tt class="constant">AstrangeUser
    </tt>.</p><p>This parameter is needed only on UNIX systems that have case
    sensitive usernames.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> = 5
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAMEMAP"></a>username map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to specify a file containing 
    a mapping of usernames from the clients to the server. This can be 
    used for several purposes. The most common is to map usernames 
    that users use on DOS or Windows machines to those that the UNIX 
    box uses. The other is to map multiple users to a single username 
    so that they can more easily share files.</p><p>The map file is parsed line by line. Each line should 
    contain a single UNIX username on the left then a '=' followed 
    by a list of usernames on the right. The list of usernames on the 
    right may contain names of the form @group in which case they 
    will match any UNIX username in that group. The special client 
    name '*' is a wildcard and matches any name. Each line of the 
    map file may be up to 1023 characters long.</p><p>The file is processed on each line by taking the 
    supplied username and comparing it with each username on the right 
    hand side of the '=' signs. If the supplied name matches any of 
    the names on the right hand side then it is replaced with the name 
    on the left. Processing then continues with the next line.</p><p>If any line begins with a '#' or a ';' then it is ignored</p><p>If any line begins with an '!' then the processing
    will stop after that line if a mapping was done by the line.
    Otherwise mapping continues with every line being processed.
    Using '!' is most useful when you have a wildcard mapping line
    later in the file.</p><p>For example to map from the name <tt class="constant">admin</tt>
    or <tt class="constant">administrator</tt> to the UNIX name <tt class="constant">
    root</tt> you would use:</p><p><span><b class="command">root = admin administrator</b></span></p><p>Or to map anyone in the UNIX group <tt class="constant">system</tt>
    to the UNIX name <tt class="constant">sys</tt> you would use:</p><p><span><b class="command">sys = @system</b></span></p><p>You can have as many mappings as you like in a username map file.</p><p>If your system supports the NIS NETGROUP option then
    the netgroup database is checked before the <tt class="filename">/etc/group
    </tt> database for matching groups.</p><p>You can map Windows usernames that have spaces in them
     by using double quotes around the name. For example:</p><p><span><b class="command">tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</b></span></p><p>would map the windows username "Andrew Tridgell" to the
    unix username "tridge".</p><p>The following example would map mary and fred to the
    unix user sys, and map the rest to guest. Note the use of the
    '!' to tell Samba to stop processing if it gets a match on
    that line.</p><pre class="programlisting">
!sys = mary fred
guest = *
</pre><p>Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences
    of usernames. Thus if you connect to \\server\fred and <tt class="constant">
    fred</tt> is remapped to <tt class="constant">mary</tt> then you
    will actually be connecting to \\server\mary and will need to
    supply a password suitable for <tt class="constant">mary</tt> not
    <tt class="constant">fred</tt>. The only exception to this is the
    username passed to the <a href="#PASSWORDSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>
    password server</tt></i></a> (if you have one). The password
    server will receive whatever username the client supplies without
    modification.</p><p>Also note that no reverse mapping is done. The main effect
    this has is with printing. Users who have been mapped may have
    trouble deleting print jobs as PrintManager under WfWg will think
    they don't own the print job.</p><p>
   Samba versions prior to 3.0.8 would only support reading the fully qualified
   username (e.g.: DOMAIN\user) from the username map when performing a
   kerberos login from a client.  However, when looking up a map
   entry for a user authenticated by NTLM[SSP], only the login name would be
   used for matches.  This resulted in inconsistent behavior sometimes
   even on the same server.
   </p><p>
   The following functionality is obeyed in version 3.0.8 and later:
   </p><p>
    When performing local authentication, the username map is
    applied to the login name before attempting to authenticate
    the connection.
    </p><p>
    When relying upon a external domain controller for validating
    authentication requests, smbd will apply the username map
    to the fully qualified username (i.e. DOMAIN\user) only
    after the user has been successfully authenticated.
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i> = 
# no username map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i> = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USESENDFILE"></a>use sendfile (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, and the <tt class="constant">sendfile()</tt> system call is supported by the underlying operating system, then some SMB read calls (mainly ReadAndX
    and ReadRaw) will use the more efficient sendfile system call for files that
    are exclusively oplocked. This may make more efficient use of the system CPU's
    and cause Samba to be faster. Samba automatically turns this off for clients
    that use protocol levels lower than NT LM 0.12 and when it detects a client is
    Windows 9x (using sendfile from Linux will cause these clients to fail).
    </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>use sendfile</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USESPNEGO"></a>use spnego (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This variable controls controls whether samba will try 
    to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with 
    WindowsXP and Windows2000 clients to agree upon an authentication mechanism. 
</p><p>
    Unless further issues are discovered with our SPNEGO
    implementation, there is no reason this should ever be
	disabled.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>use spnego</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UTMP"></a>utmp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter is only available if
	Samba has been configured and compiled  with the option <span><b class="command">
	--with-utmp</b></span>. If set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> then Samba will attempt
	to add utmp or utmpx records (depending on the UNIX system) whenever a
	connection is made to a Samba server. Sites may use this to record the
	user connecting to a Samba share.</p><p>Due to the requirements of the utmp record, we
	are required to create a unique identifier for the
	incoming user.  Enabling this option creates an n^2
	algorithm to find this number.  This may impede
	performance on large installations. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UTMPDIRECTORY"></a>utmp directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba has 
	been configured and compiled with the option <span><b class="command">
	--with-utmp</b></span>. It specifies a directory pathname that is
	used to store the utmp or utmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
	record user connections to a Samba server. By default this is 
	not set, meaning the system will use whatever utmp file the 
	native system is set to use (usually 
	<tt class="filename">/var/run/utmp</tt> on Linux).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp directory</tt></i> = 
# Determined automatically
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp directory</tt></i> = /var/run/utmp
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="-VALID"></a>-valid (S)</span></dt><dd><p> This parameter indicates whether a share is 
	valid and thus can be used. When this parameter is set to false, 
	the share will be in no way visible nor accessible.
	</p><p>
	This option should not be 
	used by regular users but might be of help to developers. 
	Samba uses this option internally to mark shares as deleted.
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>-valid</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VALIDUSERS"></a>valid users (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that should be allowed 
    to login to this service. Names starting with '@', '+' and  '&amp;'
    are interpreted using the same rules as described in the 
    <i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> parameter.</p><p>If this is empty (the default) then any user can login. 
    If a username is in both this list and the <i class="parameter"><tt>invalid 
    users</tt></i> list then access is denied for that user.</p><p>The current servicename is substituted for <i class="parameter"><tt>%S
	</tt></i>. This is useful in the [homes] section.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> = 
# No valid users list (anyone can login) 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> = greg, @pcusers
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VETOFILES"></a>veto files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of files and directories that 
	are neither visible nor accessible.  Each entry in the list must 
	be separated by a '/', which allows spaces to be included 
	in the entry. '*' and '?' can be used to specify multiple files 
	or directories as in DOS wildcards.</p><p>Each entry must be a unix path, not a DOS path and 
	must <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> include the  unix directory 
	separator '/'.</p><p>Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i> option 
	is applicable in vetoing files.</p><p>One feature of the veto files parameter that it
	is important to be aware of is Samba's behaviour when
	trying to delete a directory. If a directory that is
	to be deleted contains nothing but veto files this
	deletion will <span class="emphasis"><em>fail</em></span> unless you also set
	the <i class="parameter"><tt>delete veto files</tt></i> parameter to
	<i class="parameter"><tt>yes</tt></i>.</p><p>Setting this parameter will affect the performance 
	of Samba, as it will be forced to check all files and directories 
	for a match as they are scanned.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i> = 
# No files or directories are vetoed.
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i> = 
; Veto any files containing the word Security, 
; any ending in .tmp, and any directory containing the
; word root.
veto files = /*Security*/*.tmp/*root*/

; Veto the Apple specific files that a NetAtalk server
; creates.
veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/

</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VETOOPLOCKFILES"></a>veto oplock files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only valid when the <a href="#OPLOCKS">
	<i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i></a>
	parameter is turned on for a share. It allows the Samba administrator
	to selectively turn off the granting of oplocks on selected files that
	match a wildcarded list, similar to the wildcarded list used in the
	<a href="#VETOFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></a> 
	parameter.</p><p>You might want to do this on files that you know will 
	be heavily contended for by clients. A good example of this 
	is in the NetBench SMB benchmark program, which causes heavy 
	client contention for files ending in <tt class="filename">.SEM</tt>. 
	To cause Samba not to grant oplocks on these files you would use 
	the line (either in the [global] section or in the section for 
	the particular NetBench share :</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files</tt></i> = 
# No files are vetoed for oplock grants
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files</tt></i> = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VFSOBJECT"></a>vfs object</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for vfs objects.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VFSOBJECTS"></a>vfs objects (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the backend names which 
	are used for Samba VFS I/O operations.  By default, normal 
	disk I/O operations are used but these can be overloaded 
	with one or more VFS objects. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i> = extd_audit recycle
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VOLUME"></a>volume (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This allows you to override the volume label 
	returned for a share. Useful for CDROMs with installation programs 
	that insist on a particular volume label.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>volume</tt></i> = 
# the name of the share
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WIDELINKS"></a>wide links (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not links 
	in the UNIX file system may be followed by the server. Links 
	that point to areas within the directory tree exported by the 
	server are always allowed; this parameter controls access only 
	to areas that are outside the directory tree being exported.</p><p>Note that setting this parameter can have a negative 
	effect on your server performance due to the extra system calls 
	that Samba has to  do in order to perform the link checks.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDCACHETIME"></a>winbind cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of 
	seconds the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon will cache 
	user and group information before querying a Windows NT server 
	again.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This does not apply to authentication requests,
	these are always evaluated in real time.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind cache time</tt></i> = 300
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENABLELOCALACCOUNTS"></a>winbind enable local accounts (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not winbindd 
	will act as a stand in replacement for the various account
	management hooks in smb.conf (e.g. 'add user script').
	If enabled, winbindd will support the creation of local 
	users and groups as another source of UNIX account information
	available via getpwnam() or getgrgid(), etc...
	</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enable local accounts</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"></a>winbind enum groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be necessary to suppress 
	the enumeration of groups through the <span><b class="command">setgrent()</b></span>,
	<span><b class="command">getgrent()</b></span> and
	<span><b class="command">endgrent()</b></span> group of system calls.  If
	the <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i> parameter is
	<tt class="constant">no</tt>, calls to the <span><b class="command">getgrent()</b></span> system
	call will not return any data. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>Turning off group enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly.  </p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENUMUSERS"></a>winbind enum users (G)</span></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be
	necessary to suppress the enumeration of users through the <span><b class="command">setpwent()</b></span>,
	<span><b class="command">getpwent()</b></span> and
	<span><b class="command">endpwent()</b></span> group of system calls.  If
	the <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i> parameter is
	<tt class="constant">no</tt>, calls to the <span><b class="command">getpwent</b></span> system call
	will not return any data. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>Turning off user
	enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly.  For
	example, the finger program relies on having access to the
	full user list when searching for matching
	usernames. </p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDNESTEDGROUPS"></a>winbind nested groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If set to yes, this parameter activates the support for nested
                 groups. Nested groups are also called local groups or
                 aliases. They work like their counterparts in Windows: Nested
                 groups are defined locally on any machine (they are shared
                 between DC's through their SAM) and can contain users and
                 global groups from any trusted SAM. To be able to use nested
                 groups, you need to run nss_winbind.</p><p>Please note that per 3.0.3 this is a new feature, so 
		 handle with care.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind nested groups</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDSEPARATOR"></a>winbind separator (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows an admin to define the character 
	used when listing a username of the form of <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN
	</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i>.  This parameter 
	is only applicable when using the <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt>
	and <tt class="filename">nss_winbind.so</tt> modules for UNIX services.
	</p><p>Please note that setting this parameter to + causes problems
	with group membership at least on glibc systems, as the character +
	is used as a special character for NIS in /etc/group.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i> = '\'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i> = +
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDTRUSTEDDOMAINSONLY"></a>winbind trusted domains only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to allow Samba servers that
	are members of a Samba controlled domain to use UNIX accounts
	distributed via NIS, rsync, or LDAP as the uid's for winbindd users
	in the hosts primary domain.  Therefore, the user DOMAIN\user1 would
	be mapped to the account user1 in /etc/passwd instead of allocating
	a new uid for him or her.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind trusted domains only</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"></a>winbind use default domain (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether the
	<a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon should operate on users  
	without domain component in their username. Users without a domain
	component are treated as is part of the winbindd server's own
	domain. While this does not benifit Windows users, it makes SSH, FTP and
	e-mail function in a way much closer to the way they
	would in a native unix system.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind use default domain</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind use default domain</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSHOOK"></a>wins hook (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When Samba is running as a WINS server this 
	allows you to call an external program for all changes to the 
	WINS database. The primary use for this option is to allow the 
	dynamic update of external name resolution databases such as 
	dynamic DNS.</p><p>The wins hook parameter specifies the name of a script 
	or executable that will be called as follows:</p><p><span><b class="command">wins_hook operation name nametype ttl IP_list</b></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The first argument is the operation and is
			one  of "add", "delete", or
			"refresh". In most cases the operation
			can  be ignored as the rest of the parameters
			provide sufficient  information. Note that
			"refresh" may sometimes be called when
			the  name has not previously been added, in that
			case it should be treated  as an add.</p></li><li><p>The second argument is the NetBIOS name. If the 
			name is not a legal name then the wins hook is not called. 
			Legal names contain only  letters, digits, hyphens, underscores 
			and periods.</p></li><li><p>The third argument is the NetBIOS name 
			type as a 2 digit hexadecimal number. </p></li><li><p>The fourth argument is the TTL (time to live) 
			for the name in seconds.</p></li><li><p>The fifth and subsequent arguments are the IP 
			addresses currently registered for that name. If this list is 
			empty then the name should be deleted.</p></li></ul></div><p>An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update 
	program <span><b class="command">nsupdate</b></span> is provided in the examples 
	directory of the Samba source code. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSPROXY"></a>wins proxy (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will respond to broadcast name 
	queries on behalf of  other hosts. You may need to set this 
	to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> for some older clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wins proxy</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSSERVER"></a>wins server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP 
	address for preference) of the WINS server that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> should register with. If you have a WINS server on 
	your network then you should set this to the WINS server's IP.</p><p>You should point this at your WINS server if you have a
	multi-subnetted network.</p><p>If you want to work in multiple namespaces, you can 
	give every wins server a 'tag'. For each tag, only one 
	(working) server will be queried for a name. The tag should be 
	separated from the ip address by a colon.
	</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You need to set up Samba to point 
	to a WINS server if you have multiple subnets and wish cross-subnet 
	browsing to work correctly.</p></div><p>See the <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = mary:192.9.200.1 fred:192.168.3.199 mary:192.168.2.61
	
# For this example when querying a certain name, 192.19.200.1 will 
	be asked first and if that doesn't respond 192.168.2.61. If either 
	of those doesn't know the name 192.168.3.199 will be queried.
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = 192.9.200.1 192.168.2.61
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSSUPPORT"></a>wins support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should 
	not set this to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> unless you have a multi-subnetted network and 
	you wish a particular <span><b class="command">nmbd</b></span> to be your WINS server. 
	Note that you should <span class="emphasis"><em>NEVER</em></span> set this to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>
	on more than one machine in your network.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = no
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WORKGROUP"></a>workgroup (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what workgroup your server will 
	appear to be in when queried by clients. Note that this parameter 
	also controls the Domain name used with 
        the <a href="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"><span><b class="command">security = domain</b></span></a>
		setting.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> = WORKGROUP
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> = MYGROUP
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITABLE"></a>writable</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITEABLE"></a>writeable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Inverted synonym for <a href="#READONLY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></a>.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITECACHESIZE"></a>write cache size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
    Samba will create an in-memory cache for each oplocked file 
    (it does <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> do this for 
    non-oplocked files). All writes that the client does not request 
    to be flushed directly to disk will be stored in this cache if possible. 
    The cache is flushed onto disk when a write comes in whose offset 
    would not fit into the cache or when the file is closed by the client. 
    Reads for the file are also served from this cache if the data is stored 
    within it.</p><p>This cache allows Samba to batch client writes into a more 
    efficient write size for RAID disks (i.e. writes may be tuned to 
    be the RAID stripe size) and can improve performance on systems 
    where the disk subsystem is a bottleneck but there is free 
    memory for userspace programs.</p><p>The integer parameter specifies the size of this cache 
		(per oplocked file) in bytes.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>write cache size</tt></i> = 0
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>write cache size</tt></i> = 262144
#  for a 256k cache size per file
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITELIST"></a>write list (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that are given read-write 
    access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then 
    they will be given write access, no matter what the <a href="#READONLY">
    <i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></a>
    option is set to. The list can include group names using the 
    @group syntax.</p><p>Note that if a user is in both the read list and the 
		write list then they will be given write access.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i> = admin, root, @staff
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITERAW"></a>write raw (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not the server 
    will support raw write SMB's when transferring data from clients. 
    You should never need to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> = yes
</em></span>
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WTMPDIRECTORY"></a>wtmp directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba has 
	been configured and compiled with the option <span><b class="command">
	--with-utmp</b></span>. It specifies a directory pathname that is
	used to store the wtmp or wtmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
	record user connections to a Samba server. The difference with
	the utmp directory is the fact that user info is kept after a user 
	has logged out.</p><p>
 By default this is 
	not set, meaning the system will use whatever utmp file the 
	native system is set to use (usually 
	<tt class="filename">/var/run/wtmp</tt> on Linux).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wtmp directory</tt></i> = 
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><i class="parameter"><tt>wtmp directory</tt></i> = /var/log/wtmp
</em></span>
</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2516568"></a><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p>Although the configuration file permits service names 
	to contain spaces, your client software may not. Spaces will 
	be ignored in comparisons anyway, so it shouldn't be a 
	problem - but be aware of the possibility.</p><p>On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients - 
	limit service names to eight characters. <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has no such limitation, but attempts to connect from such 
	clients will fail if they truncate the service names.  For this reason 
	you should probably keep your service names down to eight characters 
	in length.</p><p>Use of the [homes] and [printers] special sections make life 
	for an administrator easy, but the various combinations of default 
	attributes can be tricky. Take extreme care when designing these 
	sections. In particular, ensure that the permissions on spool 
	directories are correct.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2516607"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2516618"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
	<a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2516697"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities 
	were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
	by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar 
	to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. 
	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another 
	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0 
	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for 
	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>